Algebra I m1 Teacher Materials
Algebra I m1 Teacher Materials
Algebra I m1 Teacher Materials
Mathematics Curriculum
ALGEBRA I • MODULE 1
Table of Contents1
Relationships Between Quantities and
Reasoning with Equations and Their Graphs
Module Overview .................................................................................................................................................. 3
Topic A: Introduction to Functions Studied this Year—Graphing Stories (N-Q.A.1, N-Q.A.2, N-Q.A.3,
A-CED.A.2) ............................................................................................................................................. 11
Lesson 1: Graphs of Piecewise Linear Functions .................................................................................... 13
Lesson 2: Graphs of Quadratic Functions ............................................................................................... 20
Lesson 3: Graphs of Exponential Functions ............................................................................................ 31
Lesson 4: Analyzing Graphs—Water Usage During a Typical Day at School .......................................... 41
Lesson 5: Two Graphing Stories.............................................................................................................. 49
Topic B: The Structure of Expressions (A-SSE.A.2, A-APR.A.1) ........................................................................... 59
Lesson 6: Algebraic Expressions—The Distributive Property ................................................................. 61
Lesson 7: Algebraic Expressions—The Commutative and Associative Properties ................................. 72
Lesson 8: Adding and Subtracting Polynomials ...................................................................................... 85
Lesson 9: Multiplying Polynomials ......................................................................................................... 94
Mid-Module Assessment and Rubric ................................................................................................................ 101
Topics A through B (assessment 2 days, return and remediation or further applications 4 days)
Topic C: Solving Equations and Inequalities (A-CED.A.3, A-CED.A.4, A-REI.A.1, A-REI.B.3, A-REI.C.5,
A-REI.C.6, A-REI.D.10, A-REI.D.12) ...................................................................................................... 124
Lesson 10: True and False Equations .................................................................................................... 126
Lesson 11: Solution Sets for Equations and Inequalities ...................................................................... 136
Lesson 12: Solving Equations ................................................................................................................ 150
Lesson 13: Some Potential Dangers when Solving Equations .............................................................. 159
Lesson 14: Solving Inequalities ............................................................................................................. 168
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And” or “Or” .......... 177
Lesson 16: Solving and Graphing Inequalities Joined by “And” or “Or” ............................................... 186
1 Each lesson is ONE day, and ONE day is considered a 45-minute period.
Algebra I • Module 1
Relationships Between Quantities and
Reasoning with Equations and Their Graphs
OVERVIEW
By the end of Grade 8, students have learned to solve linear equations in one variable and have applied
graphical and algebraic methods to analyze and solve systems of linear equations in two variables. Now,
students are introduced to non-linear equations and their graphs. Students formalize their understanding of
equivalent algebraic expressions and begin their study of polynomial expressions. Further, they learn that
there are some actions that, when applied to the expressions on both sides of an equal sign, will not result in
an equation with the same solution set as the original equation. Finally, they encounter problems that induce
the full modeling cycle, as it is described in the Common Core Learning Standards for Mathematics.
In Topic A, students explore the main functions that they will work with in Algebra I: linear, quadratic, and
exponential. The goal is to introduce students to these functions by having them make graphs of situations
(usually based upon time) in which the functions naturally arise (A-CED.A.2). As they graph, they reason
abstractly and quantitatively as well as choose and interpret units to solve problems related to the graphs
they create (N-Q.A.1, N-Q.A.2, N-Q.A.3).
In middle school, students applied the properties of operations to add, subtract, factor, and expand
expressions (6.EE.A.3, 6.EE.A.4, 7.EE.A.1, 8.EE.A.1). Now, in Topic B, students use the structure of
expressions to define what it means for two algebraic expressions to be equivalent. In doing so, they discern
that the commutative, associative, and distributive properties help link each of the expressions in the
collection together, even if the expressions look very different themselves (A-SSE.A.2). They learn the
definition of a polynomial expression and build fluency in identifying and generating polynomial expressions
as well as adding, subtracting, and multiplying polynomial expressions (A-APR.A.1). The Mid-Module
Assessment follows Topic B.
Throughout middle school, students practice the process of solving linear equations (6.EE.B.5, 6.EE.B.7,
7.EE.B.4, 8.EE.C.7) and systems of linear equations (8.EE.C.8). Now, in Topic C, instead of just solving
equations, they formalize descriptions of what they learned before (variable, solution sets, etc.) and are able
to explain, justify, and evaluate their reasoning as they strategize methods for solving linear and non-linear
equations (A-REI.A.1, A-REI.B.3, A-CED.A.4). Students take their experience solving systems of linear
equations further as they prove the validity of the addition method, learn a formal definition for the graph of
an equation and use it to explain the reasoning of solving systems graphically, and represent the solution to
systems of linear inequalities graphically (A-CED.A.3, A-REI.C.5, A-REI.C.6, A-REI.D.10, A-REI.D.12).
In Topic D, students are formally introduced to the modeling cycle (see page 61 of the CCLS) through
problems that can be solved by creating equations and inequalities in one variable, systems of equations, and
graphing (N-Q.A.1, A-SSE.A.1, A-CED.A.1, A-CED.A.2, A-REI.B.3). The End-of-Module Assessment follows
Topic D.
Focus Standards
Reason quantitatively and use units to solve problems.
N-Q.A.1 Use units as a way to understand problems and to guide the solution of multi-step
problems; choose and interpret units consistently in formulas; choose and interpret the
scale and the origin in graphs and data displays.★
N-Q.A.22 Define appropriate quantities for the purpose of descriptive modeling.★
N-Q.A.3 Choose a level of accuracy appropriate to limitations on measurement when reporting
quantities.★
2 This standard will be assessed in Algebra I by ensuring that some modeling tasks (involving Algebra I content or securely held content
from Grades 6-8) require the student to create a quantity of interest in the situation being described.
3 In Algebra I, tasks are limited to linear, quadratic, or exponential equations with integer exponents.
A-CED.A.4 Rearrange formulas to highlight a quantity of interest, using the same reasoning as in solving
equations. For example, rearrange Ohm’s law V = IR to highlight resistance R.★
Foundational Standards
Apply and extend previous understandings of numbers to the system of rational numbers.
6.NS.C.7 Understand ordering and absolute value of rational numbers.
a. Interpret statements of inequality as statements about the relative position of two
numbers on a number line diagram. For example, interpret –3 > –7 as a statement that
–3 is located to the right of –7 on a number line oriented from left to right.
b. Write, interpret, and explain statements of order for rational numbers in real-world
contexts. For example, write –3°C > –7°C to express the fact that –3°C is warmer than
–7°C.
4Tasks have a real-world context. In Algebra I, tasks have hallmarks of modeling as a mathematical practice (less defined tasks, more
of the modeling cycle, etc.).
Solve real-life and mathematical problems using numerical and algebraic expressions and
equations.
7.EE.B.3 Solve multi-step real-life and mathematical problems posed with positive and negative
rational numbers in any form (whole numbers, fractions, and decimals), using tools
strategically. Apply properties of operations to calculate with numbers in any form; convert
between forms as appropriate; and assess the reasonableness of answers using mental
computation and estimation strategies. For example: If a woman making $25 an hour gets
a 10% raise, she will make an additional 1/10 of her salary an hour, or $2.50, for a new
salary of $27.50. If you want to place a towel bar 9 3/4 inches long in the center of a door
that is 27 1/2 inches wide, you will need to place the bar about 9 inches from each edge; this
estimate can be used as a check on the exact computation.
Analyze and solve linear equations and pairs of simultaneous linear equations.
8.EE.C.7 Solve linear equations in one variable.
a. Give examples of linear equations in one variable with one solution, infinitely many
solutions, or no solutions. Show which of these possibilities is the case by successively
transforming the given equation into simpler forms, until an equivalent equation of the
form x = a, a = a, or a = b results (where a and b are different numbers).
b. Solve linear equations with rational number coefficients, including equations whose
solutions require expanding expressions using the distributive property and collecting
like terms.
8.EE.C.8 Analyze and solve pairs of simultaneous linear equations.
a. Understand that solutions to a system of two linear equations in two variables
correspond to points of intersection of their graphs, because points of intersection
satisfy both equations simultaneously.
b. Solve systems of two linear equations in two variables algebraically, and estimate
solutions by graphing the equations. Solve simple cases by inspection. For example, 3x
+ 2y = 5 and 3x + 2y = 6 have no solution because 3x + 2y cannot simultaneously be 5
and 6.
c. Solve real-world and mathematical problems leading to two linear equations in two
variables. For example, given coordinates for two pairs of points, determine whether
the line through the first pair of points intersects the line through the second pair.
Terminology
New or Recently Introduced Terms
Piecewise-Linear Function (Given a finite number of non-overlapping intervals on the real number
line, a (real) piecewise-linear function is a function from the union of the intervals to the set of real
numbers such that the function is defined by (possibly different) linear functions on each interval.)
Numerical Symbol (A numerical symbol is a symbol that represents a specific number.)
Variable Symbol (A variable symbol is a symbol that is a placeholder for a number. It is possible that
a question may restrict the type of number that a placeholder might permit, maybe integers only or
a positive real number, for instance.)
Numerical Expression (A numerical expression is an algebraic expression that contains only
numerical symbols (no variable symbols) and that evaluates to a single number.)
Algebraic Expression (An algebraic expression is either: (1) a numerical symbol or a variable symbol
or (2) the result of placing previously generated algebraic expressions into the two blanks of one of
the four operators ((__) + (__), (__) − (__), (__) × (__), (__) ÷ (__)) or into the base blank of an
exponentiation with an exponent that is a rational number.)
Equivalent Numerical Expressions (Two numerical expressions are equivalent if they evaluate to the
same number.)
Equivalent Algebraic Expressions (Two algebraic expressions are equivalent if we can convert one
expression into the other by repeatedly applying the commutative, associative, and distributive
properties and the properties of rational exponents to components of the first expression.)
Polynomial Expression (A polynomial expression is either: (1) a numerical expression or a variable
symbol or (2) the result of placing two previously generated polynomial expressions into the blanks
of the addition operator (__ + __) or the multiplication operator (__ × __).)
Monomial (A monomial is a polynomial expression generated using only the multiplication operator
(__ × __). Monomials are products whose factors are numerical expressions or variable symbols.)
Degree of a Monomial (The degree of a non-zero monomial is the sum of the exponents of the
variable symbols that appear in the monomial.)
Standard Form of a Polynomial Expression in One Variable (A polynomial expression with one
variable symbol 𝑥 is in standard form if it is expressed as 𝑎𝑛 𝑥 𝑛 + 𝑎𝑛−1 𝑥 𝑛−1 + ⋯ + 𝑎1 𝑥 + 𝑎0 ,
where 𝑛 is a non-negative integer, and 𝑎0 , 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑛 are constant coefficients with 𝑎𝑛 ≠ 0. A
polynomial expression in 𝑥 that is in standard form is often called a polynomial in 𝑥.)
Degree of a Polynomial in Standard Form (The degree of a polynomial in standard form is the
highest degree of the terms in the polynomial, namely 𝑛.)
Leading Term and Leading Coefficient of a Polynomial in Standard Form (The term 𝑎𝑛 𝑥 𝑛 is called
the leading term, and 𝑎𝑛 is called the leading coefficient.)
Constant Term of a Polynomial in Standard Form (The constant term is the value of the numerical
expression found by substituting 0 into all the variable symbols of the polynomial, namely 𝑎0 .)
Solution (A solution to an equation with one variable is a number in the domain of the variable that,
when substituted for all instances of the variable in both expressions, makes the equation a true
number sentence.)
Solution Set (The set of solutions of an equation is called its solution set.)
Graph of an Equation in Two Variables (The set of all points in the coordinate plane that are
solutions to an equation in two variables is called the graph of the equation.)
Zero Product Property (The Zero Product Property states that given real numbers, 𝑎 and 𝑏, if 𝑎 ∙ 𝑏 =
0 then either 𝑎 = 0 or 𝑏 = 0, or both 𝑎 and 𝑏 = 0 .)
Assessment Summary
Assessment Type Administered Format Standards Addressed
N-Q.A.1, N-Q.A.2,
Mid-Module
After Topic B Constructed response with rubric N-Q.A.3, A-APR.A.1,
Assessment Task
A-SSE.A.2
N-Q.A.1, A-SSE.A.1,
A-SSE.A.2, A-APR.A.1,
A-CED.A.1, A-CED.A.2,
End-of-Module
After Topic D Constructed response with rubric A-CED.A.3, A-CED.A.4,
Assessment Task
A-REI.A.1, A-REI.B.3,
A-REI.C.5, A-REI.C.6,
A-REI.D.10, A-REI.D.12
5
These are terms and symbols students have seen previously.
Mathematics Curriculum
ALGEBRA I • MODULE 1
Topic A:
Introduction to Functions Studied This Year—
Graphing Stories
N-Q.A.1, N-Q.A.2, N-Q.A.3, A-CED.A.2
Focus Standard: N-Q.A.1 Use units as a way to understand problems and to guide the solution of multi-
step problems; choose and interpret units consistently in formulas; and choose
and interpret the scale and the origin in graphs and data displays.
N-Q.A.2 Define appropriate quantities for the purpose of descriptive modeling.
N-Q.A.3 Choose a level of accuracy appropriate to limitations on measurement when
reporting quantities.
A-CED.A.2 Create equations in two or more variables to represent relationships between
quantities; graph equations on coordinate axes with labels and scales.
Instructional Days: 5
Lesson 1: Graphs of Piecewise Linear Functions (E) 1
Lesson 2: Graphs of Quadratic Functions (E)
Lesson 3: Graphs of Exponential Functions (E)
Lesson 4: Analyzing Graphs—Water Usage During a Typical Day at School (E)
Lesson 5: Two Graphing Stories (E)
Students explore the main functions that they will work with in Algebra I: linear, quadratic, and exponential.
The goal is to introduce students to these functions by having them make graphs of a situation (usually based
upon time) in which these functions naturally arise. As they graph, they reason quantitatively and use units
to solve problems related to the graphs they create.
For example, in Lesson 3 they watch a 20-second video that shows bacteria subdividing every few seconds.
The narrator of the video states these bacteria are actually subdividing every 20 minutes. After counting the
initial number of bacteria and analyzing the video, students are asked to create the graph to describe the
number of bacteria with respect to actual time (not the sped-up time in the video) and to use the graph to
approximate the number of bacteria shown at the end of the video.
1 Lesson Structure Key: P-Problem Set Lesson, M-Modeling Cycle Lesson, E-Exploration Lesson, S-Socratic Lesson
Another example of quantitative reasoning occurs in Lesson 4. Students are shown a graph (without labels)
of the water usage rate of a high school. The rate remains consistent most of the day but jumps every hour
for five minutes, supposedly during the bell breaks between classes. As students interpret the graph, they are
asked to choose and interpret the scale and decide on the level of accuracy of the measurements needed to
capture the behavior in the graph.
The topic ends with a lesson that introduces the next two topics on expressions and equations. Students are
asked to graph two stories that intersect in one point on the same coordinate plane. After students and
teachers form linear equations to represent both graphs and use those equations to find the intersection
point (8.EE.C.8), the question is posed to students: How can we use algebra, in general, to solve problems
like this one but for non-linear equations? Topics B and C set the stage for students’ understanding of the
general procedure for solving equations.
Student Outcomes
Students define appropriate quantities from a situation (a “graphing story”), choose and interpret the scale
and the origin for the graph, and graph the piecewise linear function described in the video. They understand
the relationship between physical measurements and their representation on a graph.
Classwork
Exploratory Challenge (20 minutes)
Show the first 1: 08 minutes of the video below, telling the class that our goal will simply be to describe in words the
motion of the man. (Note: Be sure to stop the video at 1:08 because after that the answers to the graphing questions
are given.)
Elevation vs. Time #2 [http://www.mrmeyer.com/graphingstories1/graphingstories2.mov. This is the second
video under “Download Options” at the site http://blog.mrmeyer.com/?p=213 called “Elevation vs. Time #2.”]
After viewing the video, have students share out loud their ideas on describing the motion. Some might speak in terms
MP.1 of speed, distance traveled over time, or change of elevation. All approaches are valid. Help students begin to shape
their ideas with precise language.
Direct the class to focus on the change of elevation of the man over time and begin to put into words specific details
linking elevation with time.
How high do you think he was at the top of the stairs? How did you estimate that elevation?
Were there intervals of time when his elevation wasn’t changing? Was he still moving?
Did his elevation ever increase? When?
Help students discern statements relevant to the chosen variable of elevation.
If students do not naturally do so, suggest representing this information on a
graph. As per the discussion that follows, display a set of axes on the board
with vertical axis labeled in units relevant to the elevation.
Ask these types of questions:
How should we label the vertical axis? What unit of measurement
should we choose (feet or meters)?
How should we label the horizontal axis? What unit of measurement
should we choose?
Should we measure the man’s elevation to his feet or to his head on
the graph?
The man starts at the top of the stairs. Where would that be located on the graph?
Show me with your hand what the general shape of the graph should look like.
Give time for students to draw the graph of the story (alone or in pairs). Lead a discussion through the issues of
MP.6 formalizing the diagram: The labels and units of the axes, a title for the graph, the meaning of a point plotted on the
graph, a method for finding points to plot on the graph, and so on.
MP.3 Note: The graph shown at the end of the video is incorrect! The man starts at “30 feet above the ground,” which is
clearly false. You might ask students, “Can you find the error made in the video?”
Example 1
Here is an elevation-versus-time graph of a person’s motion. Can we describe what the person might have been doing?
Have students discuss this question in pairs or in small groups. It will take some imagination to create a context that
matches the shape of the graph, and there will likely be debate.
Additional questions to ask:
What is happening in the story when the graph is increasing, decreasing, constant over time?
Answers will vary depending on the story: a person is “walking up a hill,” etc.
What does it mean for one part of the graph to be steeper than another?
The person is climbing or descending faster than in the other part.
How does the slope of each line segment relate to the context of the person’s elevation?
The slope gives the average change in elevation per minute.
Is it reasonable that a person moving up and down a vertical ladder could have produced this elevation versus
time graph?
It is unlikely because the speed is too slow: 2.5 feet per minute. If the same graph had units in seconds
then it would be reasonable.
Is it possible for someone walking on a hill to produce this elevation versus time graph and return to her
starting point at the 10-minute mark? If it is, describe what the hill might look like.
Yes, the hill could have a long path with a gentle slope that would zigzag back up to the top and then a
shorter, slightly steeper path back down to the beginning position.
What was the average rate of change of the person’s elevation between time 0 minutes and time 4 minutes?
10
ft/min, or 2.5 ft/min.
4
These types of questions help students understand that the graph represents only elevation, not speed or horizontal
distance from the starting point. This is an important observation.
Closing (5 minutes)
Ask the following:
How would you describe the graph of Example 1 to a friend?
What type of equation(s) would be required to create this graph?
Introduce the following definition to your students and discuss briefly. (We will return to this definition later in the
year.)
Piecewise-Defined Linear Function: Given non-overlapping intervals on the real number line, a (real) piecewise linear
function is a function from the union of the intervals on the real number line that is defined by (possibly different) linear
functions on each interval.
Point out that all graphs we studied today are graphs of piecewise linear functions. Remind students (see Standard
8.F.A.3) that the graphs of linear functions are straight lines, and show how each segment in one of the graphs studied
today is part of a straight line as in:
or
Also show students the intervals on which each linear function is defined. One may wish to point out there might be
ambiguity as to whether or not the endpoints of a given interval belong to that interval. For example, in the first
diagram we could argue that three linear functions are defined on the intervals [0,2), [2,5), and [5, ∞), or perhaps on
the intervals [0,2], (2,5), and [5, ∞) instead. (Warning: Your students have not been formally introduced to interval
notation.) There is no ambiguity in the second example. This point about the interval endpoints is subtle and is not an
issue to focus on in a concerted way in this particular lesson.
Exit Ticket
The graph in the Exploratory Challenge is made by combining pieces of nine linear functions (it is a piecewise linear
function). Each linear function is defined over an interval of time, represented on the horizontal axis. List those nine
time intervals.
The graph in the Exploratory Challenge is made by combining pieces of nine linear functions (it is a piecewise linear
function). Each linear function is defined over an interval of time, represented on the horizontal axis. List those nine time
intervals.
It shows a man climbing down a ladder that is 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 feet high. At time 𝟎𝟎 seconds, his shoes are at 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 feet above the
floor, and at time 𝟔𝟔 seconds, his shoes are at 𝟑𝟑 feet. From time 𝟔𝟔 seconds to the 𝟖𝟖. 𝟓𝟓 second mark, he drinks some
water on the step 𝟑𝟑 feet off the ground. After drinking the water, he takes 𝟏𝟏. 𝟓𝟓 seconds to descend to the ground
and then he walks into the kitchen. The video ends at the 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 second mark.
a. Draw your own graph for this graphing story. Use straight line segments in your graph to model the
elevation of the man over different time intervals. Label your 𝒙𝒙-axis and 𝒚𝒚-axis appropriately, and give a
title for your graph.
b. Your picture is an example of a graph of a piecewise linear function. Each linear function is defined over an
interval of time, represented on the horizontal axis. List those time intervals.
The intervals are [𝟎𝟎, 𝟔𝟔], (𝟔𝟔, 𝟖𝟖. 𝟓𝟓], (𝟖𝟖. 𝟓𝟓, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏], and (𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏], with the understanding that the inclusions of the
endpoints may vary. Students may use any notation they want to describe the intervals.
c. In your graph in part (a), what does a horizontal line segment represent in the graphing story?
d. If you measured from the top of the man’s head instead (he is 𝟔𝟔. 𝟐𝟐 feet tall), how would your graph change?
e. Suppose the ladder descends into the basement of the apartment. The top of the ladder is at ground level (𝟎𝟎
feet) and the base of the ladder is 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 feet below ground level. How would your graph change in observing
the man following the same motion descending the ladder?
f. What is his average rate of descent between time 𝟎𝟎 seconds and time 𝟔𝟔 seconds? What was his average rate
of descent between time 𝟖𝟖. 𝟓𝟓 seconds and time 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 seconds? Over which interval does he descend faster?
Describe how your graph in part (a) can also be used to find the interval during which he is descending
fastest.
𝟕𝟕
His average rate of descent between 𝟎𝟎 and 𝟔𝟔 seconds was ft/sec.
𝟔𝟔
His average rate of descent between 𝟖𝟖. 𝟓𝟓 and 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 seconds was 𝟐𝟐 ft/sec.
The interval during which he is descending the fastest corresponds to the line segment with the steepest
negative slope.
Answers will vary. A story such as the following fits the graph:
A swimmer climbs a ladder to a waterslide, sits for two seconds at the top of the slide, and then slides down the
slide into water. She stays steady at the same position underwater for two seconds before rising to the surface.
Teachers should also accept other contexts, e.g., interpreting “𝟎𝟎 elevation” as the height of a deck 𝟑𝟑 feet above
ground.
3. Draw an elevation-versus-time graphing story of your own, and then create a story for it.
Answers will vary. Do not be too critical of their graphs and stories.
Student Outcomes
Students represent graphically a non-linear relationship between two quantities and interpret features of the
graph. They will understand the relationship between physical quantities via the graph.
Lesson Notes
Distinctions between 𝒉𝒉(𝒙𝒙) and 𝒉𝒉(𝒕𝒕):
ℎ(𝑡𝑡) = 𝑎𝑎𝑡𝑡 2 + 𝑏𝑏𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐 is the height ℎ as function of time 𝑡𝑡; it is not the actual physical trajectory. It has a parabolic
“shape or trajectory” in the conceptual 𝒕𝒕-𝒉𝒉 plane. The 𝒕𝒕-𝒉𝒉 parabolic trajectory is not directly visible to the human eye.
ℎ(𝑥𝑥) = 𝑎𝑎𝑥𝑥 2 + 𝑏𝑏𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐 is the actual parabolic trajectory in the physical 𝑥𝑥-ℎ plane. The parabolic trajectory is directly
visible to the human eye. This parabolic trajectory is easily confused with the ℎ(𝑡𝑡) if we are not careful.
In the special case of projectiles with straight up-and-down vertical motions; e.g., zero horizontal speed,
ℎ(𝑡𝑡) is still parabolic when the motion is pure up and down.
ℎ(𝑥𝑥) is a “delta function” (only poorly defined at 𝑥𝑥 = 0), not a parabola.
In the special case of projectiles with a finite horizontal speed component 𝑉𝑉𝑥𝑥 (throwing a ball at an angle), 𝒕𝒕 and 𝒙𝒙 are
directly proportional because physics dictates 𝒙𝒙 = 𝑽𝑽𝒙𝒙 ∙ 𝒕𝒕. The two graphs 𝒉𝒉(𝒕𝒕) and 𝒉𝒉(𝒙𝒙) may, therefore, “look similar”
to the eyes, but they involve very different concepts.
Physics of projectiles:
In ℎ(𝑡𝑡) = 𝑎𝑎𝑡𝑡 2 + 𝑏𝑏𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐, the constants 𝑎𝑎, 𝑏𝑏, and 𝑐𝑐 have definite meanings in physics.
1
𝑎𝑎 is of the local gravitational constant. Since 𝑔𝑔 on Earth is 9.8 m/sec2 , or 32 ft/sec2 , the constant 𝑎𝑎 is,
2
numerically, always −4.9 or −16 near Earth’s surface, depending on the choice of units for the height. One
does not have the freedom to randomly choose friendly numbers in projectile word problems.
𝑏𝑏 is the initial upward speed.
𝑐𝑐 is the initial height above ground.
In ℎ(𝑥𝑥) = 𝑎𝑎𝑥𝑥 2 + 𝑏𝑏𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐, the constants 𝑎𝑎, 𝑏𝑏, and 𝑐𝑐 also have definite meanings in physics.
1
𝑎𝑎 is of the local gravitational constant divided by the square of the initial horizontal speed.
2
𝑏𝑏 is the initial slope in the 𝑥𝑥-ℎ plane, or 𝑡𝑡𝑡𝑡𝑡𝑡(𝜃𝜃).
𝑐𝑐 is the initial height above ground.
Classwork
Example 1 (8 minutes)
Show the video of a ball rolling down a ramp given at http://youtu.be/xgODzAwxrx8, telling the class that our goal will
simply be to describe in words the motion of the ball. (If the link does not work, search for “Algebra I, Module 1 Lesson 2
ball rolling down ramp video.”)
After viewing the video, have students share aloud their ideas on describing the motion. Some might speak in terms of
speed, distance rolled over time, or change of elevation. All approaches are valid. Help students begin to shape their
ideas with language that specifies the names of the quantities being observed and how they are changing over time.
Direct the class to focus on the change of elevation of the ball over time and begin to put into words specific details
linking elevation with time.
It first started at the top of the ramp.
It rolled down the ramp for about 2 seconds.
After it hit the bottom of the ramp, it rolled across the floor.
If students do not naturally do so, suggest representing this information on a graph. Display a set of axes on the board.
Begin a discussion that leads students through issues of formalizing the diagram: The labels and units of the axes, a title
for the graph, the meaning of a point plotted on the graph, the height at time 0 seconds, the time when it reached the
bottom of the ramp, etc.
Either individually or in groups of two, have students estimate the general shape of the graph of the elevation-versus-
time of the ball rolling down the ramp. At this point, do not worry about engaging students in measuring specific heights
and specific times; right now they are just looking for the general shape. Be sure to have students notice the horizontal
“tail” of the graph and ask them to interpret its meaning. (The elevation of the ball does not change as it rolls across the
floor.) Some students may draw a curved graph. Others will likely draw a straight line for the graph over the interval 0
to 1.7 seconds. Even though this is not correct, allow it at this stage.
After students have created graphs, have them compare their graphs with each other and share with the class. Ask the
following questions:
Should the change in elevation be decreasing at a constant rate? That is, do you think this graph should be a
straight line-graph, at least between 0 and about 1.7 seconds?
Some specific questions (below) can help lead to the correct conclusion:
Where does the elevation change more slowly? Explain.
If it is changing more slowly at the top and more quickly at the bottom, should the graph look the same at
those times?
In Exploratory Challenge, students will see an elevation-versus-time graph that is clearly not a straight line.
Exploratory Challenge
http://www.youtube.com/watch?v=ZCFBC8aXz-g or
Allow students to analyze the full video initially giving them as much control as possible (if not full control) in choosing
when to pause a video, or play it half speed, and so on. Perhaps conduct this part of a class in a computer lab or display
the video on an interactive Smart Board. Then direct students to investigate one of the two portions of the clip below,
depending on the level of technology you have available:
Portion 1: From time 32 seconds to time 33 seconds. Use this to get data for drawing the graph if they have
access to a powerful movie editor that can show each frame.
Portion 2: From time 48 seconds to time 53 seconds. Use this for a slow-motion version that can be analyzed
easily via YouTube.
Teacher Note: In this lesson, keep students’ focus on understanding the relationship
between physical measurements and the graph. Students will revisit scenarios like
this one in Modules 4 and 5. We know, from physics, that the height function for this
example can be modeled by 𝑠𝑠(𝑡𝑡) = 36 − 16𝑡𝑡 2 and that in this case, the function
models the situation very accurately. For example, the function predicts that he will
hit the water at exactly 1.5 seconds, which he does. However, quadratic equations
and functions are topics for later modules.
Students should start measuring from the top of the man’s jump, which is
1
about 36 feet high. (He starts at 35.5 feet and jumps a foot up before
2
falling.)
Solutions are provided below for each portion.
Give students the opportunity to share their work with the class as a whole
or with a partner. Have students articulate and justify any interesting
choices they have made. For example, instead of plotting points for every
MP.1
second of footage, some students may wish to plot the time per distance
markers (36, 30, 25, 20, 15, etc.). Both methods will lead to a graph of a
quadratic function.
Time (sec.) Elevation (ft.) Students should produce graphs that look similar to the following, according to which
0 36 clip they used:
0.33 35 Portion 1 Results: If your students used Portion 1, they should get something that
0.7 30 looks similar to the table (left) and graph (above).
1 24
1.125 20The estimates of the heights in the table are based upon the markers in the video.
1.25 15Since the video is taken from the ground, reading height directly from the video can
1.33 11be hampered by the parallax effect. Ideally, for accurate reading, the camera should
1.5 0be at the same height as the jumper AT ALL TIMES so the height reading from the
ruler in the background could be accurate. Remind the students to make some
necessary corrections or adjustments instead of just reading horizontally across the frozen video frame. Regardless, you
should not expect your students to have “perfect” graphs, but their graphs should NOT be straight lines.
Portion 2 Results: If your students used Portion 2 of the tape, they should
get something that looks similar to the table (below) and graph (right).
Have a discussion with them that the results below do not model the actual
situation. By specifically talking about film time versus real time, we lay the
foundation to talk about transformations of functions. Guide students by
asking these questions:
What would you need to do to this graph to correctly model the
jump with a graph?
You need to know how long it took for him to complete
the jump.
It takes the jumper exactly 1.5 seconds from the top of his jump
until he splashes in the water.
Then we should shrink the graph horizontally until the 𝑥𝑥-intercept
is at 1.5 seconds.
Learning how to “shrink” graphs in this way will be an important
topic in Modules 3 and 5.
As an extension, encourage students to try adjusting the graph in this way
(shrinking it horizontally such that the 𝑥𝑥-intercept is at 1.5 seconds), using
their intuition to guide them, and compare their results with their peers.
Example 2 (5 minutes)
Example 2
The table below gives the area of a square with sides of whole number lengths. Have students plot the points in the table
on a graph and draw the curve that goes through the points.
Side
𝟎𝟎 𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐 𝟑𝟑 𝟒𝟒
(cm)
Area
𝟎𝟎 𝟏𝟏 𝟒𝟒 𝟗𝟗 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
(cm2)
On the same graph, reflect the curve across the 𝒚𝒚-axis. This graph is an example of a “graph of a quadratic function.”
Bring up or ask:
On the graph, what do the points between the plotted points from the table represent?
Areas of squares with non-whole number side lengths.
Closing (3 minutes)
Ask students to use their 8th grade geometry background to reflect the graph from Example 2 across the 𝑦𝑦-axis on the
same graph they just drew (8.G.A.3). They should get a picture like this:
Mention to them that this is an example of a “graph of a quadratic function.” Students have seen functions of the form
𝐴𝐴 = 𝑠𝑠 2 in their eighth-grade studies of area as an example of a function that is not linear (8.F.A.3). Tell them that they
will be studying these functions throughout the year and that they will learn different ways to recognize and represent
quadratic functions and equations.
Extension: Show students that the graph in the Exploratory Challenge is also part of a graph of a quadratic function by
plotting the reflection across the 𝑦𝑦-axis (e.g., points with negative 𝑥𝑥-values).
MP.4
Bring up or ask:
Does this extended graph I have just drawn from the Exploratory Challenge model the elevation of the man
jumping into the shallow pool?
No, the part of the graph before time 0 was not good. He went up to the platform very slowly
compared to how fast he came down.
If time allows, have students draw a graph of the man’s elevation versus time that incorporates his climbing the ladder.
Bring up or ask:
Can you imagine an elevation versus time situation where the graph would look like the extended graph?
Yes, my elevation when I jump up into the air
If you need to, show them or have a student demonstrate the answer to this question. Finally, ask:
Does the reflection of the graph along the 𝑦𝑦-axis in Example 2 make sense?
No, squares cannot have negative side lengths.
Exit Ticket
If you jumped in the air three times, what might the elevation versus time graph of that story look like?
Label the axes appropriately.
If you jumped in the air three times, what might the elevation versus time graph of that story look like?
1. Here is an elevation versus time graph of a ball rolling down a ramp. The first section of the graph is slightly curved.
a. From the time of about 𝟏𝟏. 𝟕𝟕 seconds onwards, the graph is a flat horizontal line. If Ken puts his foot on the
ball at time 𝟐𝟐 seconds to stop the ball from rolling, how will this graph of elevation versus time change?
Even if the ball is at rest on the floor, its elevation remains 𝟎𝟎 inches and does not change. The elevation
versus time graph does not change.
b. Estimate the number of inches of change in elevation of the ball from 𝟎𝟎 seconds to 𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓 seconds. Also
estimate the change in elevation of the ball between 𝟏𝟏. 𝟎𝟎 seconds and 𝟏𝟏. 𝟓𝟓 seconds.
Between 𝟎𝟎 and 𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓 seconds, the change in elevation was about −𝟐𝟐 inches. Between 𝟏𝟏. 𝟎𝟎 and 𝟏𝟏. 𝟓𝟓 seconds,
the change in elevation was about −𝟓𝟓. 𝟓𝟓 inches.
c. At what point is the speed of the ball the fastest, near the top of the ramp at the beginning of its journey or
near the bottom of the ramp? How does your answer to part (b) support what you say?
The speed of the ball is the fastest near the bottom of the ramp. During the half-second from 𝟏𝟏. 𝟎𝟎 second to
𝟏𝟏. 𝟓𝟓 seconds, the ball’s change in elevation is greater than the half-second at the beginning of its journey. It
must have traversed a greater length of the ramp during this half-second and so was traveling faster. Its
speed is greater near the bottom of the ramp.
The video is of a man hopping up and down several times at three different heights (first, five medium-sized jumps
immediately followed by three large jumps, a slight pause, and then 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 very quick small jumps).
a. What object in the video can be used to estimate the height of the man’s jump? What is your estimate of the
object’s height?
b. Draw your own graph for this graphing story. Use parts of graphs of quadratic functions to model each of the
man’s hops. Label your 𝒙𝒙-axis and 𝒚𝒚-axis appropriately and give a title for your graph.
Answers will vary but should reflect the estimate made in part (a). See the end of the video for a picture of
the graph.
a. Plot the points (𝒙𝒙, 𝒚𝒚) in this table on a graph (except when 𝒙𝒙 is 𝟓𝟓).
b. The 𝒚𝒚-values in the table follow a regular pattern that can be discovered by computing the differences of
consecutive 𝒚𝒚-values. Find the pattern and use it to find the 𝒚𝒚-value when 𝒙𝒙 is 𝟓𝟓.
The 𝒚𝒚-values have differences that increase by one, suggesting that we next have a 𝒚𝒚-value of
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 +
𝟐𝟐
= 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝟐𝟐
when 𝒙𝒙 is 5.
c. Plot the point you found in part (b). Draw a curve through the points in your graph. Does the graph go
through the point you plotted?
Yes.
d. How is this graph similar to the graphs you drew in Examples 1 and 2 and the Exploratory Challenge?
Different?
Answers will vary. This graph is similar to the graphs from Examples 1 and 2the Exploratory Challenge in that
the curve has the same basic U-shape. (Students may mention that they are all graphs of quadratic functions,
although at this point that is not necessary.) This graph is different from the graphs from Example 1 and the
Exploratory Challenge because this curve is increasing and the graphs in Example 1 and the Exploratory
Challenge are decreasing. This graph is similar to the graph from Example 2 because they are both increasing.
However, this graph increases at a slower rate than the one from Example 2. For example this graph has
value 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 when 𝒙𝒙 is 𝟒𝟒 (the Example 2 graph had value 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏), and this graph has value 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 when 𝒙𝒙 is 𝟔𝟔 (the
Example 2 graph had value 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑), and so on.
4. A ramp is made in the shape of a right triangle using the dimensions described in the picture below. The ramp
length is 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 feet from the top of the ramp to the bottom, and the horizontal width of the ramp is 𝟗𝟗. 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 feet.
A ball is released at the top of the ramp and takes 𝟏𝟏. 𝟔𝟔 seconds to roll from the top of the ramp to the bottom. Find
each answer below to the nearest 𝟎𝟎. 𝟏𝟏 feet/sec.
a. Find the average speed of the ball over the 𝟏𝟏. 𝟔𝟔 seconds.
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
ft/sec, or 𝟔𝟔. 𝟑𝟑 ft/sec
𝟏𝟏.𝟔𝟔
b. Find the average rate of horizontal change of the ball over the 𝟏𝟏. 𝟔𝟔 seconds.
𝟗𝟗.𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
ft/sec or 𝟓𝟓. 𝟖𝟖 ft/sec
𝟏𝟏.𝟔𝟔
c. Find the average rate of vertical change of the ball over the 𝟏𝟏. 𝟔𝟔 seconds.
By the Pythagorean Theorem, the vertical length is approximately √𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟐𝟐 − 𝟗𝟗. 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 ≈ 𝟑𝟑. 𝟖𝟖 feet. Hence, the
𝟑𝟑.𝟖𝟖
average rate of vertical change is ft/sec or 𝟐𝟐. 𝟒𝟒 ft/sec
𝟏𝟏.𝟔𝟔
d. What relationship do you think holds for the values of the three average speeds you found in parts (a), (b),
and (c)? (Hint: Use the Pythagorean Theorem.)
The sum of the squares of the horizontal and vertical rates of change is equal to the square of the speed of the
ball.
Student Outcomes
Students choose and interpret the scale on a graph to appropriately represent an exponential function.
Students plot points representing the number of bacteria over time, given that bacteria grow by a constant
factor over evenly spaced time intervals.
Classwork
Example 1 (10 minutes)
MP.4 Have students sketch a graph that depicts Darryl’s change in elevation over time.
Example 1
Darryl lives on the third floor of his apartment building. His bike is locked up outside on the ground floor. At 3:00
p.m., he leaves to go run errands, but as he is walking down the stairs, he realizes he forgot his wallet. He goes
back up the stairs to get it and then leaves again. As he tries to unlock his bike, he realizes that he forgot his
keys. One last time, he goes back up the stairs to get his keys. He then unlocks his bike, and he is on his way at
3:10 p.m.
There will be variations in the students’ graphs, but the graph students produce should appear as follows:
Elevation vs Time
Exploratory Challenge
https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=gEwzDydciWc
Get students started by creating a table of the first few seconds. Stop the video as close as possible to the 0-second
mark, 1-second mark, 2-second mark, 3-second mark, and so on. Have them count the bacteria at each of those times.
Note that some of the bacteria have not fully divided, so expect a discussion on how to count them (guide them to make
the choice: approximately the length of a small bacterium). Do not suggest any model just yet as there are some great
number sense problems to explore first. Below is a fairly accurate account of the number of bacteria up to the 3-second
mark:
Time (sec) 0 1 2 3
Number of bacteria 2 4 8 16
The 4-second mark is already tricky to count (~31 or 32), as well as at the 5-second mark (~58–62). Ask students what
they might expect to see at time 6 seconds (~116–130). Do not have students count the bacteria at time 6 seconds but
instead estimate the number (e.g., the radius of the circular region of bacteria doubles roughly every second).
Students might first produce a graph similar to this:
1. Graph the number of bacteria versus time in seconds. Begin by counting the number of bacteria present at each
second and plotting the appropriate points on the set of axes below. Consider how you might handle estimating
these counts as the population of the bacteria grows.
Ask for, or eventually suggest, the following model to describe the bacteria shown in the video:
At time 0 seconds, there are 2 bacteria, and the number of bacteria in the Petri dish doubles every second.
Stress the point to your students that this model does not describe the exact number of bacteria at a given
time in the video but that it does reasonably represent an estimate of the number of bacteria at a given time.
Ask students to create a graph that represents bacterial population growth beyond the 6-second mark using this model.
Two challenges will quickly arise for students: Identifying an appropriate scale for the vertical axis and dealing with the
MP.6 extraordinarily large numbers that arise from this mark onward. Suggest that students first describe the shape of the
graph after the 6-second mark. To help with larger values, a table can be expanded beyond the 6-second mark using
scientific notation.
0 0 2
1 20 4
2 40 8
3 60 16
4 80 32
Use this table as a discussion point for justifying the change of scale for the horizontal axis.
Have them sketch a graph of the count of bacteria versus (real) time in minutes for the first five-hour period. Lead
students in a discussion to decide on appropriate scales for the vertical and horizontal axes. If needed, encourage the
students to extend their tables to determine the number of bacteria at the end of the five-hour period before they
decide on the scale. The students’ graphs do not need to match exactly the sample provided below but should
accurately depict the points over the first 300 minutes.
Students may instinctively connect the points with a smooth curve. It is acceptable to use the curve as a model of the
reality of the discrete points on the graph; however, encourage students to recognize the difference between the points
supported by the context and a continuous curve that is a model of the situation.
Now, have students redraw this graph with the unit scale of the horizontal axis as hours.
3. Graph the number of bacteria versus time in hours (for the first five hours).
Closing (5 minutes)
Tell students that the graph of the count of bacteria is an example of a “graph of an exponential function.” Have
students share the differences between linear, quadratic, and exponential graphs, first with a partner and then as a
class. Ask students to share any ideas of how to differentiate between the graph of a quadratic function and an
exponential function. Let them brainstorm and do not expect any well-formed statements about how to differentiate;
one of the goals of the year is to understand these issues. To summarize, tell your students the following:
The three types of graphs (linear, quadratic, and exponential) we have looked at over the past few days are the
“pictures” of the main types of equations and functions we will be studying throughout this year. One of our
main goals for the year is to be able to recognize linear, quadratic, and exponential relationships in real-life
situations and develop a solid understanding of these functions to model those real-life situations.
Exit Ticket
Assume that a bacteria population doubles every hour. Which of the following three tables of data, with 𝑥𝑥 representing
time in hours and 𝑦𝑦 the count of bacteria, could represent the bacteria population with respect to time? For the chosen
table of data, plot the graph of that data. Label the axes appropriately with units.
Assume that a bacteria population doubles every hour. Which of the following three tables of data, with 𝒙𝒙 representing
time in hours and 𝒚𝒚 the count of bacteria, could represent the bacteria population with respect to time? For the chosen
table of data, plot the graph of that data. Label the axes appropriately with units.
The answer is b.
1. Below are three stories about the population of a city over a period of time and four population-versus-time graphs.
Two of the stories each correspond to a graph. Match the two graphs and the two stories. Write stories for the
other two graphs, and draw a graph that matches the third story.
Story 1: The population size grows at a constant rate for some time, then doesn’t change for a while, and then
grows at a constant rate once again.
Story 2: The population size grows somewhat fast at first, and then the rate of growth slows.
Story 3: The population size declines to zero.
Story 1 corresponds to (d), and Story 2 corresponds to (b). For Story 3 answers will vary. The graph can begin at any
positive population value and decrease to 𝟎𝟎 in any manner.
Sample story for (a): The population starts out at 𝟎𝟎 and grows at a constant rate.
Sample story for (c): The population size grows at a constant linear rate for some time, then decreases at a constant
linear rate for a while, then increases at a constant linear rate slower than the original rate of increase.
Yes, this is correct. Do not be too critical of justifications. Accept any explanation that reasonably explains why she
is correct.
For the teacher: The function 𝒇𝒇(𝒕𝒕) = 𝟐𝟐(𝒕𝒕/𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐) models the number of bacteria after 𝒕𝒕 minutes starting from a single
bacterium. There are 𝟏𝟏, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 minutes in a 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐-hour period, which means that since the bacteria divide every 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
minutes, the count of the bacteria will double 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 times during a 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐-hour period. Thus, the answer is 𝒇𝒇(𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) =
𝟐𝟐𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕, which is approximately 𝟒𝟒. 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 × 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. This number is nearly 𝟓𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 billion billion bacteria.
3. Bacillus cereus is a soil-dwelling bacterium that sometimes causes food poisoning. Each cell divides to form two new
cells every 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 minutes. If a culture starts out with exactly 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 bacterial cells, how many bacteria will be present
after 𝟑𝟑 hours?
The result is 𝟐𝟐𝟔𝟔 (𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) = 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 bacteria. Students can do this by repeated multiplication, without much knowledge
of exponential functions.
Sample story for (a): Bill received his paycheck and did not touch it for a few days. Then, he bought groceries and
gas and stopped spending money. After a few more days, he spent almost all of his remaining money on a new jet
ski. A few days later he received his paycheck.
Sample story for (b): Mary is riding a Ferris wheel at a theme park.
The graph should depict the horizontal line 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟎𝟎 from 𝟎𝟎 minutes to 𝟐𝟐 minutes, a linear increase to
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 feet from 𝟐𝟐 minutes to 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 minutes, a brief free fall (concave down) curve for 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 seconds, and then a
leveled out concave up curve for the slow fall at the end.
b. According to your graph, describe the manner in which the plane climbed to its elevation of 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 feet.
Answers will vary depending on the graph. Example: I assumed that the plane climbed at a constant rate.
c. What assumption(s) did you make about falling after she opened the parachute?
Answers may vary. Example: I assumed that her change in elevation slowed down suddenly when she opened
her parachute and then was an almost constant rate of change until she reached the ground.
6. Draw a graph of the number of bacteria versus time for the following story: Dave is doing an experiment with a type
of bacteria that he assumes divides in half exactly every 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 minutes. He begins at 8:00 a.m. with 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 bacteria in a
Petri dish and waits for 𝟑𝟑 hours. At 11:00 a.m., he decides this is too large of a sample and adds Chemical A to the
dish, which kills half of the bacteria almost immediately. The remaining bacteria continue to grow in the same way.
At noon, he adds Chemical B to observe its effects. After observing the bacteria for two more hours, he observes
that Chemical B seems to have cut the growth rate in half.
Answers vary somewhat, but the graph should include the information in the table below connected by some
smooth curve. There should be a sudden decrease from 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 to 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 after time 𝟑𝟑 (i.e., 𝟑𝟑 hours), say around time
𝟑𝟑. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 or sooner, giving a nearly vertical line.
7. Decide how to label the vertical axis so that you can graph the data set on the axes below. Graph the data set and
draw a curve through the data points.
𝒙𝒙 𝒚𝒚
𝟎𝟎 −𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏 −𝟐𝟐
𝟐𝟐 −𝟒𝟒
𝟑𝟑 −𝟖𝟖
𝟒𝟒 −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟓𝟓 −𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝟔𝟔 −𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔
Student Outcomes
Students develop the tools necessary to discern units for quantities in real-world situations and choose levels
of accuracy appropriate to limitations on measurement. They refine their skills in interpreting the meaning of
features appearing in graphs.
Classwork
Exploratory Challenge (27 minutes)
Example 1
Direct students to the following graph that appears in their student materials, and ask questions about the kind of data it
represents.
The title of the graph is “Water Consumption in a Typical School Day.” For what purposes is water used at a
school?
Primarily through bathroom use.
What do you think the numbers along the horizontal axis represent?
Time of day.
What might the numbers along the vertical axis represent? Do we have any indication of the units being used?
Answers will vary. We have no indication of the units being used. We would assume that these
numbers are related, in some way, to a volume of water.
What could be the reason for the “spikes” in the graph?
Student bathroom use between class periods.
What might be the reason for the smaller spikes between the large ones?
Some student use during class time.
Example 1
Now, offer the following further information about the typical school day for the school from which this data was
recorded.
Regular school day hours: 8:00 a.m.–3:04 p.m.
After school activities: 3:15 p.m. –5:15 p.m.
Around 10:00 a.m. there is a 13 minute advisory or homeroom period.
Ask the students:
Can you see features of this information appearing in the graph?
Be sure students notice the large peaks at the times just before 8:00 a.m., near 10:00 a.m., just after 3:00 p.m., and
near 5:15 p.m., which can be explained by bathroom use just before and just after activities.
Ask the students:
Is it possible to deduce the time of lunch at this school?
Students might conjecture that lunch comes in two or three shifts so as to explain the multiple large peaks in the middle
of the day.
Now, return to the question of the numbers on the vertical axis:
Around 10:00 a.m. the graph indicates a peak of 80 units. What is the number 80 representing?
Students will likely answer “gallons of water used” or “volume of water used.” But what do we mean by “used”? Lead
to the idea that the amount “used” is measured by the volume of water that drains through the pipes and leaves the
school.
Then ask the question:
How does one actually measure the amount of water flowing out through the pipes precisely at 10:00 a.m.?
What does “80 units of water leaving the school” right at 10:00 a.m. mean?
The issue to be discussed next is that 80 units of water must take some period of time to flow out
through the pipes.
Ask students to think about the bell for the end of class. At this time, they will all rise and begin to walk out of the
classroom, “flowing” through the door of the classroom. If there are 25 students in the class, would I say that “a volume
of 25 students is flowing through the door” right at an instant? No, we have instead a “flow of 25 students” over a short
period of time.
Ask students to consider again what the number 80 at the 10:00 a.m. mark might mean.
Now add the following information:
The researchers who collected this data watched the school’s water meter during a 12-hour period. The meter
shows the total amount of water (in gallons) that has left the school since the time the meter was last set to
zero. Since the researchers did not know when this resetting last occurred, they decided, at each minute mark
during the day, to measure how much the meter reading increased over the next minute of time. Thus, the
value “80” at the 10: 00 a.m. mark on the graph means that 80 gallons of water flowed through the meter and
thus left the school during the period from 10:00 a.m. to 10:01 a.m.
Ask the students:
MP.2 What are the units for the numbers on the vertical axis?
The units for the numbers on the vertical axis are gallons per minute.
Ignoring the large spikes in the graph, what seems to be the typical range of values for water use during the
school day?
Help students notice that the value of the graph between the large spikes seems to oscillate between the flow of 0
gallons of water per minute and about 15 gallons of water per minute.
Now have students complete Exercises 1 and 2 independently and then work in pairs or in small groups to discuss
MP.1 approaches and compare answers. Ask students to volunteer their answers to a general class discussion. Discuss any
assumptions that were made to arrive at answers.
Exercises 1–2
Exercises
1. The bulk of water usage is due to the flushing of toilets. Each flush uses 𝟐𝟐. 𝟓𝟓 gallons of water. Samson estimates
that 𝟐𝟐% of the school population uses the bathroom between 10:00 a.m. and 10:01 a.m. right before homeroom.
What is a good estimate of the population of the school?
𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖
We know that 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 gallons of water are used during that minute. This corresponds to = 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 flushes. Assuming
𝟐𝟐.𝟓𝟓
that each student flushes just once, we can say that 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 students used the bathroom during this time. This
represents 𝟐𝟐% of the school population, which is one fiftieth of the school population. Thus, there are about 𝟏𝟏, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔
people at the school.
2. Samson then wonders this: If everyone at the school flushed a toilet at the same time, how much water would go
down the drain (if the water-pressure of the system allowed)? Are we able to find an answer for Samson?
Answers will vary based on assumptions made. If there were enough toilets that everyone could flush a toilet at the
same time, and using the estimated school population of 𝟏𝟏, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 (there would have to be 𝟏𝟏, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 toilets), then
𝟏𝟏, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 × 𝟐𝟐. 𝟓𝟓 gallons = 𝟒𝟒, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 gallons of water.
3. Estimation Exercise
Make a guess as to how many toilets are at the school.
𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖
Make a guess as to how many students are in the school, and what percentage of students might be using the
bathroom at break times between classes, just before the start of school, and just after the end of school. Are
there enough toilets for the count of students wishing to use them?
Of 𝟏𝟏, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 students, at any given break time, 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐% are using the restroom.
Using the previous two considerations, estimate the number of students using the bathroom during the peak
minute of each break.
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 students are using the bathroom during a break, but maybe only one fourth of them at any one minute,
so 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 at any one minute.
Assuming each flush uses 𝟐𝟐. 𝟓𝟓 gallons of water, estimate the amount of water being used during the peak
minute of each break.
What time of day do these breaks occur? (If the school schedule varies, consider today’s schedule.)
Answers will vary by school; an example: 𝟖𝟖: 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟗𝟗: 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏: 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏: 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟏𝟏: 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒, 𝟑𝟑: 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
Draw a graph that could represent the water consumption in a typical school day of your school.
Exit Ticket
Suppose the researchers collecting data for water consumption during a typical school day collected data through the
night too.
1. For the period between the time the last person leaves the building for the evening and the time of the arrival of the
first person the next morning, how should the graph of water consumption appear?
2. Suppose the researchers see instead, from the time 1:21 a.m. onwards, the graph shows a horizontal line of
constant value, 4. What might have happened during the night?
Suppose the researchers collecting data for water consumption during a typical school day collected data through the
night too.
1. For the period between the time the last person leaves the building for the evening and the time of the arrival of the
first person the next morning, how should the graph of water consumption appear?
Since no toilets are being used, the graph should be a horizontal line of constant value zero.
2. Suppose the researchers see instead, from the time 1:21 a.m. onwards, the graph shows a horizontal line of
constant value, 𝟒𝟒. What might have happened during the night?
Perhaps one toilet started to leak at 1:21 a.m., draining water at a rate of 𝟒𝟒 gallons per minute.
1. The following graph shows the temperature (in degrees Fahrenheit) of La Honda, CA in the months of August and
September of 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. Answer the questions following the graph.
The graph seems to alternate between peak, valley, peak. Explain why.
The temperature increases during the day and drops during the night, and the difference between the high
and low temperatures can be very large.
When do you think it should be the warmest during each day? Circle the peak of each day to determine if the
graph matches your guess.
The warmest time should be before sunset, a few hours after noon, since heating occurs throughout the day
while the sun is up.
When do you think it should be the coldest during each day? Draw a dot at the lowest point of each day to
determine if the graph matches your guess.
Similarly, the coldest temperature should be before sunrise, since cooling occurs throughout the night.
Does the graph do anything unexpected such as not following a pattern? What do you notice? Can you
explain why it’s happening?
The graph seems to follow the expected pattern with natural variations, except for the unusually low daytime
temperatures on August 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑st.
2. The following graph shows the amount of precipitation (rain, snow, or hail) that accumulated over a period of time
in La Honda, CA.
On August 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐th, the measurement started with an initial cumulative data of 𝟎𝟎. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 inches. It stands for the
precipitation accumulated before the current measurement. Nothing else happened until August 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑st, when
there were 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 inches of precipitation. On September 𝟏𝟏st, there were 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 more inches of precipitation.
The term “accumulate” in context of the graph means to add up the amounts of precipitation over time. The
graph starts on August 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐th. Why didn’t the graph start at 𝟎𝟎 inches instead of starting at 𝟎𝟎. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 inches?
On August 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐th, the measurement started with an initial cumulative data of 𝟎𝟎. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 inches. It stands for the
precipitation accumulated before the current measurement.
3. The following graph shows the solar radiation over a period of time in La Honda, CA. Solar radiation is the amount
of the sun’s rays that reach the Earth’s surface.
This represents time periods during which the solar radiation per unit area is constant. For example during
night time, there is no sun light, and hence there are flat regions on the curve.
What do you think is happening when the peaks are very low?
It could be an overcast day. Other less common events such as solar eclipse would also cause this.
Looking at all three graphs above, what do you conclude happened on August 31st, 2012 in La Honda, CA?
The lower temperature, increase in accumulated precipitation, and the low solar radiation makes me think
that August 31st, 2012 was overcast and rainy for most of the day.
4. The following graph shows the velocity (in centimeters per second) and turbidity of the Logan River in Queensland,
Australia during a flood. Turbidity refers to the clarity of the water (higher turbidity means murkier water) and is
related to the total amount of suspended solids, such as clay, silt, sand, and phytoplankton, present in the water.
For recreation, Jill visited the river during the month of January and saw clean and beautiful water. On which
day do you think she visited?
The 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏th appears to be the best choice because of the low turbidity. The 𝟖𝟖th and 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏th are also good choices.
What do the negative velocities (below the grey line) that appear periodically at the beginning represent?
This shows normal tidal flow, which is disturbed during the flood.
The behavior of the river seems to follow a normal pattern at the beginning and at the very end of the time
period shown. Approximately when does the flood start? Describe its effects on velocity and turbidity.
The flood starts on the 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏th. It increases the velocity so that it is always positive, disturbing the tide, and it
increases the turbidity of the water.
Student Outcomes
Students interpret the meaning of the point of intersection of two graphs and use analytic tools to find its
coordinates.
Classwork
Example 1 (7 minutes)
Have students read the situation and sketch a graphing story. Prompt them to visualize both the story and what the
graph will look like as they read the situation. Share a few student responses.
Some students may raise questions:
Are the two people traveling at the same rate? If yes, how would their graphs compare?
If they were, the graphs of the lines would have opposite slopes.
You may also need to clarify what it means to graph Earl’s distance from Maya’s door. His distance should be decreasing
as time passes. Earl’s distance is represented by the dotted line. Notice that this graph shows the story ending when the
two people meet each other in the hallway, and it assumes they travel at the same rate. Do not spend too much time
developing content or equations here. The rest of the lesson will provide a more formal approach.
Example 1
Maya and Earl live at opposite ends of the hallway in their apartment building. Their doors are 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 feet apart. Each starts
at his or her own door and walks at a steady pace toward each other and stop when they meet.
What would their graphing stories look like if we put them on the same graph? When the two people meet in the
hallway, what would be happening on the graph? Sketch a graph that shows their distance from Maya’s door.
Exploratory Challenge
http://youtu.be/X956EvmCevI
The video shows man and a girl walking on the same stairway.
Exercises 1–4
2. Add the girl’s elevation to the same graph. How did you
account for the fact that the two people did not start at
the same time?
Have the students form groups and produce a group graph on whiteboards or poster paper in response to these
exercises. Students might have questions about how to incorporate information depicting the motion of the second
person. After a few minutes, have students hold up what they have drawn. Give the class further opportunity to revise
their own graphs if they wish. Call out groups that have labeled and scaled their axes and ask follow-up questions to
elicit their thinking when they created their graphs. The goal should be that all groups have a roughly accurate sketch
with axes labeled. Students may struggle with starting the 2nd person at a point along the horizontal axis. Clarify that
MP.1 time 0 represents the time when the first person started walking up the stairs. Work with students by stopping and
starting the video to refine and scale their graphs. Estimate that each rise of each stair is 8 inches. There are 16 stairs
2
with a maximum elevation of 10 ft.
3
Sketch the graph on the board and label the intersection point 𝑃𝑃. Ask the following questions:
Does it seem reasonable to say that each graph is composed of linear segments?
Most students will accept that linear functions represent a good model. We might assume that each
person is ascending or descending at a constant rate.
3. Suppose the two graphs intersect at the point 𝑷𝑷(𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟒𝟒). What is the meaning of this point in this situation?
Many students will respond that 𝑷𝑷 is where the two people pass each other on the stairway.
Lead a discussion that highlights these more subtle points before proceeding.
We have two elevation-versus-time graphs, one for each of the two people (and that time is being measured in
the same way for both people).
The point 𝑃𝑃 lies on the elevation-versus-time graph for the first person, AND it also lies on the elevation-
versus-time graph for the second person.
We know the coordinates of the point 𝑃𝑃. These coordinates mean that since the first person is at an elevation
of 4 feet at 24 seconds, the second person is also at an elevation of 4 feet at 24 seconds.
4. Is it possible for two people, walking in stairwells, to produce the same graphs you have been using and NOT pass
each other at time 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 seconds? Explain your reasoning.
Yes, they could be walking in separate stairwells. They would still have the same elevation of 𝟒𝟒 feet at time
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 seconds but in different locations.
Give students time to revise their work after you discuss this with the entire class.
Example 2
Duke starts at the base of a ramp and walks up it at a constant rate. His elevation increases by three feet every second.
Just as Duke starts walking up the ramp, Shirley starts at the top of the same 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 foot high ramp and begins walking down
the ramp at a constant rate. Her elevation decreases two feet every second.
Exercises 5–7
5. Sketch two graphs on the same set of elevation-versus-time axes to represent Duke’s and Shirley’s motions.
6. What are the coordinates of the point of intersection of the two graphs? At what time do Duke and Shirley pass
each other?
(𝟓𝟓, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏)
𝒕𝒕 = 𝟓𝟓
7. Write down the equation of the line that represents Duke’s motion as he moves up the ramp and the equation of
the line that represents Shirley’s motion as she moves down the ramp. Show that the coordinates of the point you
found in the question above satisfy both equations.
If 𝒚𝒚 represents elevation in feet and 𝒕𝒕 represents time in seconds, then Duke’s elevation satisfies 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 and
Shirley’s 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. The lines intersect at (𝟓𝟓, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏), and this point does indeed lie on both lines.
Exercise 6 has a similar scenario to Example 1. After students work this exercise in small groups, have each group share
their results as time permits. Circulate around the classroom providing assistance to groups as needed.
Use the results of the exercises in Example 2 to close this session.
How did you figure out the slope of your linear equations from the story? Why was Shirley’s slope negative?
The slope is the rate of change, feet per second. Shirley's slope was negative because she was walking
down the ramp, and thus her elevation was decreasing over time.
Why did Shirley’s graph and equation have the 𝑦𝑦-intercept (0, 25)?
MP.3 The 𝑦𝑦-intercept was (0, 25) because at time equal to 0, Shirley was at an elevation of 25 ft.
What was easier in this problem, determining the intersection point algebraically or graphically? When might
an algebraic approach be better?
Students could answer either, depending on the accuracy of their graphs. An algebraic approach would
be better when the graphs intersect at non-integer values.
Lesson Summary
The intersection point of the graphs of two equations is an ordered pair that is a solution to BOTH equations. In the
context of a distance (or elevation) story, this point represents the fact that both distances (or elevations) are equal
at the given time.
Graphing stories with quantities that change at a constant rate can be represented using piecewise linear
equations.
Exit Ticket
Maya and Earl live at opposite ends of the hallway in their apartment
building. Their doors are 50 feet apart. Each person starts at his or
her own door and walks at a steady pace towards the other. They
stop walking when they meet.
Suppose:
Maya walks at a constant rate of 3 feet every second.
Earl walks at a constant rate of 4 feet every second.
Maya and Earl live at opposite ends of the hallway in their apartment building. Their doors are 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 feet apart. Each
person starts at his or her own door and walks at a steady pace towards the other. They stop walking when they meet.
Suppose:
1. Reread the story about Maya and Earl from Example 1. Suppose that Maya walks at a constant rate of 𝟑𝟑 feet every
second and Earl walks at a constant rate of 𝟒𝟒 feet every second starting from 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 feet away. Create equations for
each person’s distance from Maya’s door and determine exactly when they meet in the hallway. How far are they
from Maya’s door at this time?
b. Create linear equations that represent each girl’s mileage in terms of time in minutes. You will need two
equations for July since her pace changes after 𝟒𝟒 laps (𝟏𝟏 mile).
Equations for May, June, and July are shown below. Notice that July has two equations since her speed
changes after her first mile, which occurs 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 minutes after May starts running.
𝟏𝟏
May: 𝒅𝒅 = 𝒕𝒕
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏
June: 𝒅𝒅 = (𝒕𝒕 − 𝟓𝟓)
𝟗𝟗
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
July: 𝒅𝒅 = (𝒕𝒕 − 𝟕𝟕), 𝒕𝒕 ≤ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and 𝒅𝒅 = (𝒕𝒕 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) + 𝟏𝟏, 𝒕𝒕 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟔𝟔 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
d. Did June and July pass May on the track? If they did, when and at what mileage?
Assuming that they started at the same place, June passes May at time 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. 𝟓𝟓 minutes at the 𝟐𝟐. 𝟓𝟓 mile marker.
July does not pass May.
e. Did July pass June on the track? If she did, when and at what mileage?
𝟐𝟐
July passes June at time 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 minutes at the mile marker.
𝟑𝟑
3. Suppose two cars are travelling north along a road. Car 1 travels at a constant speed of 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 mph for two hours, then
speeds up and drives at a constant speed of 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 mph for the next hour. The car breaks down and the driver has to
stop and work on it for two hours. When he gets it running again, he continues driving recklessly at a constant
speed of 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 mph. Car 2 starts at the same time that Car 1 starts, but Car 2 starts 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 miles farther north than Car
1 and travels at a constant speed of 𝟐𝟐𝟓𝟓 mph throughout the trip.
a. Sketch the distance versus time graphs for Car 1 and Car 2 on a coordinate plane. Start with time 𝟎𝟎 and
measure time in hours.
A graph is shown below that approximates the two cars traveling north.
c. Tell the entire story of the graph from the point of view of Car 2. (What does the driver of Car 2 see along the
way and when?)
The driver of Car 2 is carefully driving along at 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 mph, and he sees Car 1 pass him at 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 mph after about
𝟏𝟏
𝟐𝟐 hours. About an hour and a half later, he sees Car 1 broken down along the road. After about another
𝟐𝟐
hour and a half, Car 1 whizzes past again.
d. Create linear equations representing each car’s distance in terms of time (in hours). Note that you will need
four equations for Car 1 and only one for Car 2. Use these equations to find the exact coordinates of when
the cars meet.
Using the variables, 𝒅𝒅 for distance (in miles) and 𝒕𝒕 for time (in hours):
𝒅𝒅 = 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓, 𝟎𝟎 ≤ 𝒕𝒕 ≤ 𝟐𝟐,
𝒅𝒅 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏(𝒕𝒕 − 𝟐𝟐) + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏(𝒕𝒕 − 𝟏𝟏), 𝟐𝟐 < 𝒕𝒕 ≤ 𝟑𝟑
𝒅𝒅 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟑𝟑 < 𝒕𝒕 ≤ 𝟓𝟓
𝒅𝒅 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏(𝒕𝒕 − 𝟓𝟓) + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏(𝒕𝒕 − 𝟑𝟑), 𝟓𝟓 < 𝒕𝒕
Intersection points:
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 (𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐)(𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐)
First: solving 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏(𝒕𝒕 − 𝟏𝟏) = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 gives � , + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏� ≈ (𝟐𝟐. 𝟕𝟕, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. 𝟕𝟕),
𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕
Second: solving 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 gives (𝟒𝟒, 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐), and
𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 (𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐)(𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒)
Third: solving 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏(𝒕𝒕 − 𝟑𝟑) = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 gives � , + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏� ≈ (𝟓𝟓. 𝟑𝟑, 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. 𝟑𝟑).
𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕
4. Suppose that in Problem 3 above, Car 1 travels at the constant speed of 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 mph the entire time. Sketch the
distance versus time graphs for the two cars on the graph below. Do the cars ever pass each other? What is the
linear equation for Car 1 in this case?
A sample graph is shown below. Car 1 never overtakes Car 2, and they are 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 miles apart the entire time. The
equation for Car 1 is 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐.
5. Generate six distinct random whole numbers between 𝟐𝟐 and 𝟗𝟗 inclusive and fill in the blanks below with the
numbers in the order in which they were generated.
a. On a coordinate plane, plot points 𝑨𝑨, 𝑩𝑩, and 𝑪𝑪. Draw line segments from point 𝑨𝑨 to point 𝑩𝑩, and from point
𝑩𝑩 to point 𝑪𝑪.
b. On the same coordinate plane, plot points 𝑫𝑫 and 𝑬𝑬 and draw a line segment from point 𝑫𝑫 to point 𝑬𝑬.
c. Write a graphing story that describes what is happening in this graph. Include a title, 𝒙𝒙- and 𝒚𝒚-axis labels, and
scales on your graph that correspond to your story.
6. The following graph shows the revenue (or income) a company makes from designer coffee mugs and the total cost
(including overhead, maintenance of machines, etc.) that the company spends to make the coffee mugs.
14000
12000
10000
Dollars 8000
6000 Total Cost
4000 Revenue
2000
0
0 200 400 600 800 1000
Units Produced and Sold
a. How are revenue and total cost related to the number of units of coffee mugs produced?
Definition: Profit = Revenue − Cost. Revenue is the income from the sales and is directly proportional to the
number of coffee mugs actually sold; it does not depend on the units of coffee mugs produced. Total cost is
the sum of the fixed costs (overhead, maintaining the machines, rent, etc.) PLUS the production costs
associated with the number of coffee mugs produced; it does not depend on the number of coffee mugs sold.
b. What is the meaning of the point (𝟎𝟎, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒) on the total cost line?
The overhead costs, the costs incurred regardless of whether 𝟎𝟎 or 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 coffee mugs are made or sold, is
$𝟒𝟒, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎.
c. What are the coordinates of the intersection point? What is the meaning of this point in this situation?
(𝟓𝟓𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔). The revenue, $𝟔𝟔, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, from selling 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 coffee mugs, is equal to the total cost, $𝟔𝟔, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, of
producing 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 coffee mugs. This is known as the break-even point. When Revenue = Cost, the Profit is $𝟎𝟎.
After this point, the more coffee mugs sold, the more the positive profit; before this point, the company loses
money.
d. Create linear equations for revenue and total cost in terms of units produced and sold. Verify the coordinates
of the intersection point.
If 𝒖𝒖 is a whole number for the number of coffee mugs produced and sold, 𝑪𝑪 is the total cost to produce 𝒖𝒖
mugs, and 𝑹𝑹 is the total revenue when 𝒖𝒖 mugs are sold, then
𝑪𝑪 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒,
𝑹𝑹 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
When 𝒖𝒖 = 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓, both 𝑪𝑪 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝟒𝟒 ∙ 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 = 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 and 𝑹𝑹 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 ∙ 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 = 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔.
e. Profit for selling 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 units is equal to revenue generated by selling 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 units minus the total cost of
making 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 units. What is the company’s profit if 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 units are produced and sold?
Profit = Revenue − Total Cost. Hence, 𝑷𝑷 = 𝑹𝑹 − 𝑪𝑪 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 ∙ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − (𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝟒𝟒 ∙ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖
= 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
The company’s profit is $𝟒𝟒, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎.
Mathematics Curriculum
ALGEBRA I • MODULE 1
Topic B:
The Structure of Expressions
A-SSE.A.1, A-SSE.A.2
Focus Standard: A-SSE.A.2 Use the structure of an expression to identify ways to rewrite it. For example,
see x4 – y4 as (x2)2 – (y2)2, thus recognizing it as a difference of squares that can
be factored as (x2 – y2)(x2 + y2).
A-APR.A.1 Understand that polynomials form a system analogous to the integers, namely,
they are closed under the operations of addition, subtraction, and
multiplication; add, subtract, and multiply polynomials.
Instructional Days: 4
Lesson 6: Algebraic Expressions—The Distributive Property (P) 1
Lesson 7: Algebraic Expressions—The Commutative and Associative Properties (S)
Lesson 8: Adding and Subtracting Polynomials (S)
Lesson 9: Multiplying Polynomials (P)
In Lessons 6 and 7 of this topic, students develop a precise understanding of what it means for expressions to
be algebraically equivalent. By exploring geometric representations of the distributive, associative, and
commutative properties for positive whole numbers and variable expressions assumed to represent positive
whole numbers, students confirm their understanding of these properties and expand them to apply to all
real numbers. Students use the properties to generate equivalent expressions and formalize that two
algebraic expressions are equivalent if we can convert one expression into the other by repeatedly applying
the commutative, associative, and distributive properties and the properties of rational exponents to
components of the first expression. A goal of this topic is to address a fundamental, underlying question:
Why are the commutative, associative, and distributive properties so important in mathematics? 2 The answer
to the question is, of course, because these three properties help to generate all equivalent algebraic
expressions discussed in Algebra I.
1Lesson Structure Key: P-Problem Set Lesson, M-Modeling Cycle Lesson, E-Exploration Lesson, S-Socratic Lesson
2The welcomed removal of parentheses from expressions through the use of order of operations and other tricks greatly simplifies
how we write expressions, but those same tricks also make it appear as if the associative property is never used when rewriting
expressions.
Lessons 6 and 7 also engage students in their first experience using a recursive definition for building
algebraic expressions. Recursive definitions are sometimes confused with being circular in nature because
the definition of the term uses the very term one is defining. However, a recursive definition or process is not
circular because it has what is referred to as a base case. For example, a definition for algebraic expression is
presented as follows:
An algebraic expression is either:
1. A numerical symbol or a variable symbol or
2. The result of placing previously generated algebraic expressions into the two blanks of one of the
four operators ((__) + (__), (__) − (__), (__) × (__), (__) ÷ (__)) or into the base blank of an
exponentiation with an exponent that is a rational number.
Part (1) of this definition serves as a base case, stating that any numerical or variable symbol is in itself an
algebraic expression. The recursive portion of the definition is in part (2) where one can use any previously
generated algebraic expression to form new ones using the given operands. Recursive definitions are an
important part of the study of sequences in Module 3. Giving students this early experience lays a nice
foundation for the work to come.
Having a clear understanding of how algebraic expressions are built and what makes them equivalent
provides a foundation for the study of polynomials and polynomial expressions.
In Lessons 8 and 9, students learn to relate polynomials to integers written in base 𝑥𝑥, rather than our
traditional base of 10. The analogies between the system of integers and the system of polynomials continue
as they learn to add, subtract, and multiply polynomials and to find that the polynomials for a system that is
closed under those operations (e.g., a polynomial added to, subtracted from, or multiplied by another
polynomial) always produces another polynomial.
We use the terms polynomial and polynomial expression in much the same way as we use the terms number
and numerical expression. Where we would not call 27(3 + 8) a number, we would call it a numerical
expression. Similarly, we reserve the word polynomial for polynomial expressions that are written as a sum
of monomials.
Student Outcomes
Students use the structure of an expression to identify ways to rewrite it.
Students use the distributive property to prove equivalency of expressions.
Lesson Notes
The previous five lessons introduced the graphs of the functions students will study in this algebra course. These next
lessons change the focus from graphs to expressions and their structures. In Grades 5–8, the term “expression” was
described but not formally defined, and many subtleties may have been overlooked. For example, the associative
property may not have been made explicit; 3 ∙ 5 ∙ 7, for instance, is really (3 ∙ 5) ∙ 7. The lessons that follow will formally
define algebraic expression and the equivalency of algebraic expressions and simultaneously introduce students to the
notion of a recursive definition, which later becomes a major aspect of Algebra I (recursive sequences). Lesson 6 begins
with an expression-building competition. As this is a strange, abrupt change of direction for students from the previous
five lessons, it may be worthwhile to mention this change.
In middle school you learned to find equations for straight line graphs such as the ones that appear in Lesson 1,
but as we saw in Lessons 2 and 3, not all graphs are linear. It would be nice to develop the machinery for
developing equations for those too, if at all possible. Note that Lesson 4 indicates that graphs still might be
very complicated and finding a single equation for them might not be possible. We may, however, be able to
find equations that produce graphs that approximate the graphs, or sections thereof. Also, Lesson 5 points out
the value of finding the point of intersection of two graphs. Our goal is to develop the algebraic tools to do
this.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (13 minutes)
The following is known as the “4-number game.” It challenges students to write each
Scaffold:
positive integer as a combination of the digits 1, 2, 3, and 4; each used at most once,
combined via the operations of addition and multiplication only, as well as grouping Should you feel your students
symbols. For example, 24 can be expressed as (1 + 3)(2 + 4). Students may use would benefit from it, you may
parentheses or not, at their own discretion (as long as their expressions evaluate to the optionally begin the lesson
given number, following the order of operations). Digits may not be juxtaposed to with the “3-number game”
represent larger whole numbers, so you cannot use the numerals 1 and 2 to create the using only the digits 1, 2, and
number 12 for instance. 3.
Play the 4-number game as a competition within pairs. Give the students 3 minutes to express the longest list of
numbers they can, each written in terms of the digits 1, 2, 3, and 4. Students may want to use small dry erase boards to
play this game or pencil and paper. Optionally, consider splitting up the tasks (e.g., 1–8, 9–20, 21–30, 31–36) and
assign them to different groups.
Below are some sample expressions the students may build and a suggested structure for displaying possible expressions
on the board as students call out what they have created.
When reviewing the game, it is likely that students will have different expressions for the same number (see answers to
rows 7 and 8 given below). Share alternative expressions on the board and discuss as a class the validity of the
expressions.
Challenge the students to come up with more than one way to create the number 21.
Discussion (5 minutes)
We have seen that both 1 + 2 + 3 and 1 ∙ 2 ∙ 3 evaluate to 6. Does it seem reasonable that for any real
numbers, 𝑎, 𝑏, and 𝑐, that 𝑎 + 𝑏 + 𝑐 would be equivalent to 𝑎 ∙ 𝑏 ∙ 𝑐?
No, students will likely quickly think of counterexamples. (Proceed to the next bullet point regardless.)
How can we show geometrically that they are not generally equivalent? Assume that 𝑎, 𝑏, and 𝑐, are positive
integers. Does it seem intuitive that these two geometric representations are equivalent?
The geometric representations do not suggest equivalency.
Therefore, it does not appear that being numerically equivalent in one specific case implies equivalency in
other, more general cases.
Perhaps we should play a game like this with symbols.
Let’s consider first what the effect would be of allowing for repeat use of symbols in the 4-number game.
With the repeat use of symbols, we can build larger and larger expressions by making use of expressions we already
possess. For example, from 10 = 1 + 2 + 3 + 4, we can generate the number 110 by making repeated use of the
MP.7 expression:
110 = 10 ∙ 10 + 10 = (1 + 2 + 3 + 4) ∙ (1 + 2 + 3 + 4) + (1 + 2 + 3 + 4).
Exercise 2 (1 minute)
Exercise 2
Using the numbers 𝟏, 𝟐, 𝟑, 𝟒 only once and the operations + or × as many times as you like, write an expression that
evaluates to 𝟏𝟔. Use this expression and any combination of those symbols as many times as you like to write an
expression that evaluates to 𝟖𝟏𝟔.
(𝟒 + 𝟑 + 𝟏) × 𝟐
((𝟒 + 𝟑 + 𝟏) × 𝟐)((𝟒 + 𝟑 + 𝟏) × 𝟐 + (𝟒 + 𝟑 + 𝟏) × 𝟐 + (𝟒 + 𝟑 + 𝟏) × 𝟐) + (𝟒 + 𝟑 + 𝟏) × 𝟐 + (𝟒 + 𝟑 + 𝟏) × 𝟐
+ (𝟒 + 𝟑 + 𝟏) × 𝟐
Exercise 3 (5 minutes)
Suppose we now alter the 4-number game to be as follows:
Exercise 3
a. Begin by choosing an initial set of symbols, variable or numeric, as a starting set of expressions.
𝟑, 𝒙, 𝒚, and 𝒂
b. Generate more expressions by placing any previously created expressions into the blanks of the addition
operator: ______ + _______.
𝟑 + 𝒂 or 𝒙 + 𝒚 or 𝒚 + 𝟑 or 𝒂 + 𝒂
Let’s play the game using 3, 𝑥, 𝑦, and 𝑎 as our set of starting expressions.
Write the symbols to be used on the board. (These are not provided in the student materials.)
Can you see that:
Part (1) of the game gives us 3, 𝑥, 𝑦, and 𝑎 to start.
Part (2) gives us expressions, such as 3 + 𝑎 or 𝑥 + 𝑦 or 𝑦 + 3 or 𝑎 + 𝑎.
Repeated use of part (2) then gives (3 + 𝑎) + 3 or 𝑥 + (𝑥 + 𝑦) and (𝑥 + 𝑦) + (𝑥 + 𝑦), for example,
and then ((𝑥 + 𝑦) + (𝑥 + 𝑦)) + 𝑎 for example, etc.
Make sure students are clear that in this version of the game, we are going to limit ourselves to addition (no
multiplication).
Take 1 minute to generate as many expressions as you can, following the rules of the game. (Time the students
for 1 minute.)
Compare your list with your neighbor. Did your neighbor follow the rules of the game?
If you followed the rules, you end up generating strings of sums. Is that correct?
Is it possible to create the expression 4𝑥 + 5𝑦 + 3𝑎 from the game?
Ask a student to verbally describe how they did it and show the string of sums on the board.
Exercise 4 (4 minutes)
Scaffold: At the teacher’s discretion, begin with the problem 2𝑥 + 3𝑥 = 5𝑥. Or offer the problem just the way it is
given, and allow students to ponder and struggle for a bit. Then, suggest “If you are not sure, let’s try this one: is 2𝑥 +
3𝑥 = 5𝑥 an application of the distributive property?”
Exercise 4
Roma says that collecting like terms can be seen as an application of the distributive property. Is writing 𝒙 + 𝒙 = 𝟐𝒙 an
application of the distributive property?
Exercise 5
Leela is convinced that (𝒂 + 𝒃)𝟐 = 𝒂𝟐 + 𝒃𝟐. Do you think she is right? Use a picture to illustrate your reasoning.
Exercise 6
Answer:
A good discussion to have with your students is whether it is important that the length of 1 in the width be the same as
the length of 1 in the height. Continue the discussion as to whether it is important how you label the picture to
represent the quantities.
Exercise 7
Answer:
Closing (7 minutes)
The previous exercises demonstrate the distributive property of arithmetic, which we believe to hold for all real
numbers, not just the positive whole numbers. The choice of the word “belief” is intended to reinforce the notion with
students that we accept the property as true without the need for proof.
We can see, geometrically, that the following are true for whole numbers (display on the board):
(𝑎 + 𝑏)2 = 𝑎2 + 2𝑎𝑏 + 𝑏 2
(𝑎 + 𝑏 + 1) × (𝑏 + 1) = 𝑎𝑏 + 𝑏 2 + 𝑎 + 2𝑏 + 1
(𝑎 + 𝑏) × (𝑐 + 𝑑) × (𝑒 + 𝑓 + 𝑔) = 𝑎𝑐𝑒 + 𝑎𝑐𝑓 + 𝑎𝑐𝑔 + 𝑎𝑑𝑒 + 𝑎𝑑𝑓 + 𝑎𝑑𝑔 + 𝑏𝑐𝑒 + 𝑏𝑐𝑓 + 𝑏𝑐𝑔 + 𝑏𝑑𝑒 + 𝑏𝑑𝑓 + 𝑏𝑑𝑔
Do we also believe these statements to be true for all real numbers: 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐, 𝑑, 𝑒, 𝑓, 𝑔?
Which of these statements are extensions of the Distributive Property of arithmetic (stated in your student
materials)?
All of them.
The Distributive Property: If 𝒂, 𝒃, and 𝒄 are real numbers, then 𝒂(𝒃 + 𝒄) = 𝒂𝒃 + 𝒂𝒄.
Lesson Summary
The distributive property represents a key belief about the arithmetic of real numbers. This property can be applied
to algebraic expressions using variables that represent real numbers.
Exit Ticket
2. Using starting symbols of 𝒘, 𝒒, 𝟐, and −𝟐, which of the following expressions will NOT appear when following the
rules of the game played in Exercise 3?
a. 𝟕𝒘 + 𝟑𝒒 + (−𝟐)
b. 𝒒−𝟐
c. 𝒘−𝒒
d. 𝟐𝒘 + 𝟔
e. −𝟐𝒘 + 𝟐
Expressions (c) and (e) cannot be obtained in this exercise.
3. Luke wants to play the 𝟒-number game with the numbers 𝟏, 𝟐, 𝟑, and 𝟒 and the operations of addition,
multiplication, AND subtraction.
Leoni responds, “Or we just could play the 𝟒-number game with just the operations of addition and multiplication,
but now with the numbers −𝟏, −𝟐, −𝟑, −𝟒, 𝟏, 𝟐, 𝟑, and 𝟒 instead.”
Subtraction can be viewed as the addition of a negative (e.g., 𝒙 − 𝟒 = 𝒙 + (−𝟒)). By introducing negative integers,
we need not consider subtraction as a new operation.
5.
a. Given that 𝒂 > 𝒃, which of the shaded regions is larger and why?
The shaded region from the image on the left is larger than the shaded region from the image on the right.
Both images are made up of the region of area 𝒂 × 𝒃 plus another region of either 𝟐𝒂 (for the image on the
left) or 𝟐𝒃 (for the image on the right) since 𝒂 > 𝒃, 𝟐𝒂 > 𝟐𝒃.
b. Consider the expressions 𝟖𝟓𝟏 × 𝟐𝟗 and 𝟖𝟒𝟗 × 𝟑𝟏. Which would result in a larger product? Use a diagram to
demonstrate your result.
Edna looked at the diagram and then highlighted the four small rectangles shown and concluded:
a. Michael, when he saw the picture, highlighted four rectangles and concluded:
b. Jill, when she saw the picture, highlighted eight rectangles and squares (not including the square in the
middle) to conclude:
c. When Fatima saw the picture, she exclaimed: (𝒙 + 𝟐𝒂)𝟐 = 𝒙𝟐 + 𝟒𝒂(𝒙 + 𝟐𝒂) − 𝟒𝒂𝟐. She claims she
highlighted just four rectangles to conclude this. Identify the four rectangles she highlighted and explain how
using them she arrived that the expression 𝒙𝟐 + 𝟒𝒂(𝒙 + 𝟐𝒂) − 𝟒𝒂𝟐.
She highlighted each of the four rectangles that form a rim around the inner square. In doing so, she double
counted each of the four 𝒂 × 𝒂 corners and, therefore, needed to subtract 𝟒𝒂𝟐.
Yes, all of the techniques are right. You can see how each one is correct using the diagrams. The students
broke the overall area into parts and added up the parts. In Fatima’s case, she ended up counting certain
areas twice and had to compensate by subtracting those areas back out of her sum.
Student Outcomes
Students use the commutative and associative properties to recognize structure within expressions and to
prove equivalency of expressions.
Classwork
Exercises 1–4 (15 minutes)
Have students discuss the following four exercises in pairs. Discuss the answers as a class.
Exercise 1
Ben looks at this picture from the opposite side of the table and says, “You drew 𝟒 + 𝟑.”
Explain why Ben might interpret the picture this way.
Ben read the picture from his left to his right on his side of the table.
Exercise 2
Suzy adds more to her picture and says, “The picture now represents (𝟑 + 𝟒) + 𝟐.”
Reading from right to left, the solution would be (𝟐 + 𝟒) + 𝟑. Make sure students have parentheses around 𝟐 + 𝟒.
Exercise 3
Suzy then draws another picture of squares to represent the product 𝟑 × 𝟒. Ben moves to the end of the table and says,
“From my new seat, your picture looks like the product 𝟒 × 𝟑.”
What picture might Suzy have drawn? Why would Ben see it differently from his viewpoint?
Squares should be arranged in a grid. If a student responds that Suzy made 𝟑 rows of 𝟒, then Ben’s viewpoint would be 𝟒
rows of 𝟑. Students should understand that Ben is seated to Suzy’s left or right now, not across from her. Some students
may need scaffolding here—have them physically move to see the different viewpoint.
Exercise 4
Draw a picture to represent the quantity (𝟑 × 𝟒) × 𝟓 that also could represent the quantity (𝟒 × 𝟓) × 𝟑 when seen from
a different viewpoint.
Student solutions could vary here. Students may consider representing the problem as a 𝟑 by 𝟒 by 𝟓 rectangular box.
When viewed from different faces, the different expressions appear. With the 𝟑 by 𝟒 rectangle viewed as its base, the
volume of the box might be computed as (𝟑 × 𝟒) × 𝟓. But with the 𝟒 by 𝟓 rectangle viewed as its base, its volume would
be computed as (𝟒 × 𝟓) × 𝟑. Some students will likely repeat the 𝟑 × 𝟒 pattern 𝟓 times in a row. This diagram viewed
from the end of the table would be 𝟒 dots repeated 𝟓 times arranged in 3 columns.
Next, have students review the four properties of arithmetic provided in the student materials and ask the following:
The Associative Property of Addition: If 𝒂, 𝒃, and 𝒄 are real numbers, then (𝒂 + 𝒃) + 𝒄 = 𝒂 + (𝒃 + 𝒄).
The Associative Property of Multiplication: If 𝒂, 𝒃, and 𝒄 are real numbers, then (𝒂𝒃)𝒄 = 𝒂(𝒃𝒄).
Can you relate each of these properties to one of the previous exercises?
Exercise 1 connects with the commutative property of addition.
Exercise 2 connects with the associative property of addition. (Students might mention that the
commutative property of addition is also relevant to this exercise. This will be discussed fully in Exercise
5.)
Exercise 3 connects with the commutative property of multiplication.
Exercise 4 connects the associative property of multiplication. (Students might mention that the
commutative property of multiplication is also relevant to this exercise. This will be discussed fully in
Exercise 6.)
Point out that the four opening exercises suggest that the commutative and associative properties of addition and
multiplication are valid for whole numbers and probably apply to all real numbers as well. However, there is a weakness
in the geometric models since negative side lengths and areas are not meaningful. We choose to believe these
properties hold for all real numbers, including negative numbers.
Exercise 5
Viewing the diagram below from two different perspectives illustrates that (𝟑 + 𝟒) + 𝟐 equals 𝟐 + (𝟒 + 𝟑).
(Note: The direct application of the associative property of addition only gives (𝒙 + 𝒚) + 𝒛 = 𝒙 + (𝒚 + 𝒛).)
To answer this exercise with the class, create a “flow diagram” on the board as follows. This flow diagram will show how
one can apply both the commutative and associative properties to prove the equivalence of these two expressions.
Have students copy this work into their handouts.
Start by showing the application of each property on the expression (𝑥 + 𝑦) + 𝑧.
Here “A” represents an application of the associative property and “C” an application of the commutative property. Be
sure students understand the application of the commutative property shown here.
Point out that we can extend this diagram by applying the commutative and associative properties to the new
expressions in the diagram.
Note that there are multiple branches and options for extending this diagram. Direct the students to discover options
that will chart a path from (𝑥 + 𝑦) + 𝑧 to (𝑧 + 𝑦) + 𝑥. Two possible paths are as follows:
Choose one of the paths in the flow diagram and show on the board how to write it as a mathematical proof of the
statement that (𝑥 + 𝑦) + 𝑧 and (𝑧 + 𝑦) + 𝑥 are equivalent expressions. For example, for the lower of the two paths
shown, write the following:
(𝑥 + 𝑦) + 𝑧 = 𝑧 + (𝑥 + 𝑦) commutative property
= 𝑧 + (𝑦 + 𝑥) commutative property
= (𝑧 + 𝑦) + 𝑥 associative property
Exercise 6 (5 minutes)
Exercise 6
Draw a flow diagram and use it to prove that (𝒙𝒚)𝒛 = (𝒛𝒚)𝒙 for all real numbers 𝒙, 𝒚, and 𝒛.
Students will likely realize the answer here is completely analogous to the solution to the previous exercise.
(𝑥𝑦)𝑧 = 𝑧(𝑥𝑦) commutative property
= 𝑧(𝑦𝑥) commutative property
= (𝑧𝑦)𝑥 associative property
Exercise 7 (5 minutes)
Exercise 7
Use these abbreviations for the properties of real numbers and complete the flow diagram.
Answer:
Exercise 8 (2 minutes)
Exercise 8
Let 𝒂, 𝒃, 𝒄, and 𝒅 be real numbers. Fill in the missing term of the following diagram to show that ((𝒂 + 𝒃) + 𝒄) + 𝒅 is
sure to equal 𝒂 + (𝒃 + (𝒄 + 𝒅)).
𝒂 + ((𝒃 + 𝒄) + 𝒅)
This example illustrates that it is possible to prove, through repeated use of the associative property, that any
two arrangements of parentheses around a given sum are equivalent expressions. For this reason it is deemed
unnecessary to place parentheses among a sum of terms. (Present the following on the board.)
((𝑎 + 𝑏) + 𝑐) + 𝑑
𝑎 + (𝑏 + (𝑐 + 𝑑)) “𝑎 + 𝑏 + 𝑐 + 𝑑”
(𝑎 + 𝑏) + (𝑐 + 𝑑)
From now on, we will accept this as common practice. In presenting a proof, writing the following:
(𝑥 + (𝑦 + 𝑧) + (𝑤 + 6)) = ((𝑥 + 𝑦) + (𝑧 + 𝑤) + 6) by the associative property
OR
Closing (5 minutes)
Throughout this lesson, we have used symbols for numbers and symbols for placeholders for numbers to create
expressions. Let us now formalize these notions with definitions.
It is possible that a question may restrict the type of number that a placeholder might permit; e.g., integers only or
positive real numbers.
For example, 𝑥 and 3 are algebraic expressions, and from that we can create the expression 𝑥 + 3 by placing
each into the blanks of the addition operator. From there, we can create the expression 𝑥(𝑥 + 3) by placing 𝑥
and 𝑥 + 3 into the blanks of the multiplication operator, and so on. According to this general definition, we can
𝑥(𝑥+3) −2
also create expressions of the form ( ) .
3𝑥 2
Our notion of two expressions being “equivalent” has also been vague. We can now pinpoint what we mean:
Two algebraic expressions are equivalent if we can convert one expression into the other by repeatedly applying the
commutative, associative, and distributive properties and the properties of rational exponents to components of the first
expression.
Numerical Expression: A numerical expression is an algebraic expression that contains only numerical symbols (no
variable symbols), which evaluate to a single number.
Equivalent Numerical Expressions: Two numerical expressions are equivalent if they evaluate to the same number.
For example, although we formally proved (3 + 4) + 2 equals (2 + 4) + 3 through the commutative and
associative properties, it is more reasonable to note that they both evaluate to 9.
Note that 𝟏 + 𝟐 + 𝟑 and 𝟏 × 𝟐 × 𝟑, for example, are equivalent numerical expressions (they are both 𝟔) but 𝒂 + 𝒃 + 𝒄
and 𝒂 × 𝒃 × 𝒄 are not equivalent expressions.
Lesson Summary
The commutative and associative properties represent key beliefs about the arithmetic of real numbers. These
properties can be applied to algebraic expressions using variables that represent real numbers.
Two algebraic expressions are equivalent if we can convert one expression into the other by repeatedly applying
the commutative, associative, and distributive properties and the properties of rational exponents to components
of the first expression.
Exit Ticket
1. The following portion of a flow diagram shows that the expression 𝒂𝒃 + 𝒄𝒅 is equivalent to the expression 𝒅𝒄 + 𝒃𝒂.
Fill in each circle with the appropriate symbol: Either 𝑪+ (for the “commutative property of addition”) or 𝑪× (for the
“commutative property of multiplication”).
Answer:
2. Fill in the blanks of this proof showing that (𝒘 + 𝟓)(𝒘 + 𝟐) is equivalent 𝒘𝟐 + 𝟕𝒘 + 𝟏𝟎. Write either
“commutative property,” “associative property,” or “distributive property” in each blank.
3. Fill in each circle of the following flow diagram with one of the letters: C for commutative property (for either
addition or multiplication), A for associative property (for either addition or multiplication), or D for distributive
property.
Answer:
4. What is a quick way to see that the value of the sum 𝟓𝟑 + 𝟏𝟖 + 𝟒𝟕 + 𝟖𝟐 is 𝟐𝟎𝟎?
5.
𝟏
a. If 𝒂𝒃 = 𝟑𝟕 and 𝒙𝒚 = , what is the value of the product 𝒙 × 𝒃 × 𝒚 × 𝒂?
𝟑𝟕
𝒙 × 𝒃 × 𝒚 × 𝒂 = (𝒙𝒚)(𝒂𝒃) = 𝟏
b. Give some indication as to how you used the commutative and associative properties of multiplication to
evaluate 𝒙 × 𝒃 × 𝒚 × 𝒂 in part (a).
c. Did you use the associative and commutative properties of addition to answer Question 4?
6. The following is a proof of the algebraic equivalency of (𝟐𝒙)𝟑 and 𝟖𝒙𝟑 . Fill in each of the blanks with either the
statement “commutative property” or “associative property.”
(𝟐𝒙)𝟑 = 𝟐𝒙 ∙ 𝟐𝒙 ∙ 𝟐𝒙
= 𝟐(𝒙 × 𝟐)(𝒙 × 𝟐)𝒙 associative property
= 𝟖𝒙𝟑
8.
a. Suppose we are to play the 𝟒-number game with the symbols 𝒂, 𝒃, 𝒄, and 𝒅 to represent numbers, each used
at most once, combined by the operation of addition ONLY. If we acknowledge that parentheses are
unneeded, show there are essentially only 𝟏𝟓 expressions one can write.
By also making use of the commutative property of addition, we have the expressions:
𝒂, 𝒃, 𝒄, 𝒅, 𝒂 + 𝒃, 𝒂 + 𝒄, 𝒂 + 𝒅, 𝒃 + 𝒄, 𝒃 + 𝒅, 𝒄 + 𝒅,
𝒂 + 𝒃 + 𝒄, 𝒂 + 𝒃 + 𝒅, 𝒂 + 𝒄 + 𝒅, 𝒃 + 𝒄 + 𝒅, 𝒂 + 𝒃 + 𝒄 + 𝒅
b. How many answers are there for the multiplication ONLY version of this game?
𝒙𝒂
𝒙𝒂 ∙ 𝒙𝒃 = 𝒙𝒂+𝒃 = 𝒙𝒂−𝒃 (𝒙𝒂 )𝒃 = 𝒙𝒂𝒃
𝒙𝒃
𝒙 𝒂 𝒙𝒂
(𝒙𝒚)𝒂 = 𝒙𝒂 𝒚𝒂 ( ) = 𝒂
𝒚 𝒚
b. (𝟐𝒙)𝟒 (𝟐𝒙)𝟑
𝟏𝟐𝟖𝒙𝟕
𝒘𝟖
Optional Challenge:
11. Grizelda has invented a new operation that she calls the “average operator.” For any two real numbers 𝒂 and 𝒃, she
declares 𝒂 ⨁ 𝒃 to be the average of 𝒂 and 𝒃:
𝒂+𝒃
𝒂⨁𝒃=
𝟐
a. Does the average operator satisfy a commutative property? That is, does 𝒂 ⨁ 𝒃 = 𝒃 ⨁ 𝒂 for all real numbers
𝒂 and 𝒃?
𝒙 𝟏
Yes, use the fact that = ∙ 𝒙 for any real number 𝒙 and the commutative property.
𝟐 𝟐
𝒂+𝒃 𝟏 𝟏 𝒃+𝒂
𝒂⨁𝒃= = ∙ (𝒂 + 𝒃) = ∙ (𝒃 + 𝒂) = =𝒃⨁𝒂
𝟐 𝟐 𝟐 𝟐
b. Does the average operator distribute over addition? That is, does 𝒂⨁(𝒃 + 𝒄) = (𝒂⨁𝒃) + (𝒂⨁𝒄) for all real
numbers 𝒂, 𝒃, and 𝒄?
Student Outcomes
Students understand that the sum or difference of two polynomials produces another polynomial and relate
polynomials to the system of integers; students add and subtract polynomials.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (7 minutes)
Have students complete Exercise 1(a) and use it for a brief discussion on the notion of base. Then have students
continue with the remainder of the exercise.
Exercise 1
a. How many quarters, nickels, and pennies are needed to make $𝟏𝟏. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏?
Exercise 2 (5 minutes)
In Exercise 2, we are laying the foundation that polynomials written in standard form are simply base 𝑥𝑥 “numbers.” The
practice of filling in specific values for 𝑥𝑥 and finding the resulting values lays a foundation for connecting this algebra of
polynomial expressions with the later lessons on polynomial functions (and other functions) and their inputs and
outputs.
Work through Exercise 2 with the class.
Exercise 2
Now let’s be as general as possible by not identifying which base we are in. Just call the base 𝒙𝒙.
Consider the expression 𝟏𝟏 × 𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 + 𝟐𝟐 × 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟕𝟕 × 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑 × 𝟏𝟏, or equivalently 𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 + 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟕𝟕𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑.
𝟏𝟏, 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝟖𝟖, 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗
Point out that the expression we see here is just the generalized form of their answer from part (b) of Exercise 1.
However, as we change 𝑥𝑥, we get a different number each time.
Exercise 3
a. When writing numbers in base 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, we only allow coefficients of 𝟎𝟎 through 𝟗𝟗. Why is that?
Once you get ten of a given unit, you also have one of the unit to the left of that.
b. What is the value of 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑 when 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟓𝟓? How much money is 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 nickels and 𝟑𝟑 pennies?
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
$𝟏𝟏. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
𝟐𝟐
d. What number is represented by 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐 if 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟐𝟐 or if 𝒙𝒙 = ?
𝟑𝟑
−𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟗𝟗
𝟏𝟏
e. What number is represented by −𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + √𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + when 𝒙𝒙 = √𝟐𝟐?
𝟐𝟐
𝟕𝟕
−
𝟐𝟐
Point out, as highlighted by Exercises 1 and 3, that carrying is not necessary in this type of expression (polynomial
expressions). For example, 4𝑥𝑥 2 + 17𝑥𝑥 + 2 is a valid expression. However, in base ten arithmetic, coefficients of value
ten or greater are not conventional notation. Setting 𝑥𝑥 = 10 in 4𝑥𝑥 2 + 17𝑥𝑥 + 2 yields 4 hundreds, 17 tens, and 2 ones,
which is to be expressed as 5 hundreds, 7 tens, and 2 ones.
Compare your polynomial expressions with a neighbor’s. Do your neighbor’s expressions fall into the category
of polynomial expressions?
Resolve any debates as to whether a given expression is indeed a polynomial expression by referring back to the
definition and discussing as a class.
Note that the definition of a polynomial expression includes subtraction (add the additive inverse instead),
dividing by a non-zero number (multiply by the multiplicative inverse instead), and even exponentiation by a
non-negative integer (use the multiplication operator repeatedly on the same numerical or variable symbol).
List several of the student-generated polynomials on the board. Include some that contain more than one variable.
Initiate the following discussion, presenting expressions on the board when relevant.
Just as the expression (3 + 4) ∙ 5 is a numerical expression but not a number, (𝑥𝑥 + 5) + (2𝑥𝑥 2 − 𝑥𝑥)(3𝑥𝑥 + 1) is a
polynomial expression but not technically a polynomial. We reserve the word polynomial for polynomial
expressions that are written simply as a sum of monomial terms. This begs the question: What is a monomial?
A monomial is a polynomial expression generated using only the multiplication operator (__×__). Thus, it does
not contain + or − operators.
Just as we would not typically write a number in factored form and still refer to it as a number (we might call it a
number in factored form), similarly, we do not write a monomial in factored form and still refer to it as a
monomial. We multiply any numerical factors together and condense multiple instances of a variable factor
using (whole number) exponents.
Try creating a monomial.
Compare the monomial you created with your neighbor’s. Is your neighbor’s expression really a monomial? Is
it written in the standard form we use for monomials?
There are also such things as binomials and trinomials. Can anyone make a conjecture about what a binomial is
and what a trinomial is and how they are the same or different from a polynomial?
Students may conjecture that a binomial has two of something and that a trinomial three of something. Further, they
might conjecture that a polynomial has many of something. Allow for discussion and then state the following:
A binomial is the sum (or difference) of two monomials. A trinomial is the sum (or difference) of three
monomials. A polynomial, as stated earlier, is the sum of one or more monomials.
The degree of a monomial is the sum of the exponents of the variable symbols that appear in the monomial.
The degree of a polynomial is the degree of the monomial term with the highest degree.
While polynomials can contain multiple variable symbols, most of our work with polynomials will be with
polynomials in one variable.
What do polynomial expressions in one variable look like? Create a polynomial expression in one variable and
compare with your neighbor.
Post some of the student generated polynomials in one variable on the board.
Let’s relate polynomials to the work we did at the beginning of the lesson.
Is this expression an integer in base 10? 10(100 + 22 − 2) + 3(10) + 8 − 2(2)
Is the expression equivalent to the integer 1,234?
How did we find out?
We rewrote the first expression in our standard form, right?
Polynomials in one variable have a standard form as well. Use your intuition of what standard form of a
polynomial might be to write this polynomial expression as a polynomial in standard form:
2𝑥𝑥(𝑥𝑥 2 − 3𝑥𝑥 + 1) − (𝑥𝑥 3 + 2) and compare your result with your neighbor.
Students should arrive at the answer 𝑥𝑥 3 − 6𝑥𝑥 2 + 2𝑥𝑥 − 2.
Confirm that in standard form, we start with the highest degreed monomial, and continue in descending order.
The leading term of a polynomial is the term of highest degree that would be written first if the polynomial is
put into standard form. The leading coefficient is the coefficient of the leading term.
What would you imagine we mean when we refer to the constant term of the polynomial?
A constant term is any term with no variables. To find “the constant” term of a polynomial, be sure you
have combined any and all constant terms into one single numerical term, written last if the polynomial
is put into standard form. Note that a polynomial does not have to have a constant term (or could be
said to have a constant term of 0).
As an extension for advanced students, assign the task of writing of a formal definition for standard form of a
polynomial. The formal definition is provided below for your reference:
A polynomial expression with one variable symbol 𝑥𝑥 is in standard form if it is expressed as, 𝑎𝑎𝑛𝑛 𝑥𝑥 𝑛𝑛 +
𝑎𝑎𝑛𝑛−1 𝑥𝑥 𝑛𝑛−1 + ⋯ + 𝑎𝑎1 𝑥𝑥 + 𝑎𝑎0 , where 𝑛𝑛 is a non-negative integer, and 𝑎𝑎0 , 𝑎𝑎1 , 𝑎𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑎𝑛𝑛 are constant coefficients
with 𝑎𝑎𝑛𝑛 ≠ 0. A polynomial expression in 𝑥𝑥 that is in standard form is often called a polynomial in 𝑥𝑥.
Exercise 4 (5 minutes)
Exercise 4
Find each sum or difference by combining the parts that are alike.
𝟔𝟔𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝟖𝟖
𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 + 𝟓𝟓
𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
Closing (3 minutes)
How are polynomials analogous to integers?
While integers are in base 10, polynomials are in base 𝑥𝑥.
If you add two polynomials together, is the result sure to be another polynomial? The difference of two
polynomials?
Students will likely reply, “yes,” based on the few examples and their intuition.
Are you sure? Can you think of an example where adding or subtracting two polynomials does not result in a
polynomial?
Students thinking about 𝑥𝑥 2 − 𝑥𝑥 2 = 0 could suggest not. At this point, review the definition of a
polynomial. Constant symbols are polynomials.
Lesson Summary
A monomial is a polynomial expression generated using only the multiplication operator (__×__). Thus, it does not
contain + or − operators. Monomials are written with numerical factors multiplied together and variable or other
symbols each occurring one time (using exponents to condense multiple instances of the same variable).
The degree of a monomial is the sum of the exponents of the variable symbols that appear in the monomial.
The degree of a polynomial is the degree of the monomial term with the highest degree.
Exit Ticket
Yes.
1. Celina says that each of the following expressions is actually a binomial in disguise:
For example, she sees that the expression in (i) is algebraically equivalent to 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟐𝟐𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐, which is indeed a
binomial. (She is happy to write this as 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + (−𝟐𝟐)𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐, if you prefer.)
Is she right about the remaining four expressions?
She is right about the remaining four expressions. They all can be expressed as binomials.
2. Janie writes a polynomial expression using only one variable, 𝒙𝒙, with degree 𝟑𝟑. Max writes a polynomial expression
using only one variable, 𝒙𝒙, with degree 𝟕𝟕.
a. What can you determine about the degree of the sum of Janie’s and Max’s polynomials?
b. What can you determine about the degree of the difference of Janie’s and Max’s polynomials?
3. Suppose Janie writes a polynomial expression using only one variable, 𝒙𝒙, with degree of 𝟓𝟓, and Max writes a
polynomial expression using only one variable, 𝒙𝒙, with degree of 𝟓𝟓.
a. What can you determine about the degree of the sum of Janie’s and Max’s polynomials?
The maximum degree could be 𝟓𝟓, but it could also be anything less than that. For example, if Janie’s
polynomial were 𝒙𝒙𝟓𝟓 + 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 − 𝟏𝟏, and Max’s were −𝒙𝒙𝟓𝟓 + 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏, the degree of the sum is only 𝟐𝟐.
b. What can you determine about the degree of the difference of Janie’s and Max’s polynomials?
The maximum degree could be 𝟓𝟓, but it could also be anything less than that.
4. Find each sum or difference by combining the parts that are alike.
a. (𝟐𝟐𝒑𝒑 + 𝟒𝟒) + 𝟓𝟓(𝒑𝒑 − 𝟏𝟏) − (𝒑𝒑 + 𝟕𝟕)
𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 − 𝟖𝟖
𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 + 𝟔𝟔
𝟒𝟒𝒕𝒕𝟐𝟐 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 + 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟔𝟔
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝟖𝟖
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟐𝟐
𝟑𝟑
h. (𝟗𝟗 − 𝒕𝒕 − 𝒕𝒕𝟐𝟐 ) − (𝟖𝟖𝒕𝒕 + 𝟐𝟐𝒕𝒕𝟐𝟐 )
𝟐𝟐
−𝟒𝟒𝒕𝒕𝟐𝟐 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝟗𝟗
−𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 + 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 − 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
Student Outcomes
Students understand that the product of two polynomials produces another polynomial; students multiply
polynomials.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (15 minutes)
Exercise 1
Can you explain what she is doing? What is her final answer?
She is using an area model, finding the area of each rectangle and adding them together. Her final answer is
𝟕𝟕, 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖.
Encourage students to recognize that in parts (b) and (c), the terms along the diagonals were all like terms; however, in
part (d) one of the factors has no 𝑥𝑥-term. Allow students to develop a strategy for dealing with this, concluding with the
suggestion of inserting the term + 0𝑥𝑥, for a model that looks like the following:
Students may naturally ask about the division of polynomials. This topic will be covered in Grade 11, Module 1. The
extension challenge at the end of the lesson, however, could be of interest to students inquiring about this.
Could we have found this product without the aid of a geometric model? What would that look like?
Go through the exercise applying the distributive property and collecting like terms. As a scaffold, remind students that
variables are placeholders for numbers. If 𝑥𝑥 = 5, for example, whatever the quantity on the right is (270), you have
5 − 1 of “that quantity”, or 5 of “that quantity” minus 1 of “that quantity”. Similarly we have 𝑥𝑥 of that quantity, minus 1
of that quantity:
(𝑥𝑥 − 1)(𝑥𝑥 3 + 6𝑥𝑥 2 − 5)
𝑥𝑥(𝑥𝑥 3 + 6𝑥𝑥 2 − 5) − 1(𝑥𝑥 3 + 6𝑥𝑥 2 − 5)
𝑥𝑥 4 + 6𝑥𝑥 3 − 5𝑥𝑥 − 𝑥𝑥 3 − 6𝑥𝑥 2 + 5
𝑥𝑥 4 + 5𝑥𝑥 3 − 6𝑥𝑥 2 − 5𝑥𝑥 + 5
Exercise 2 (5 minutes)
Have students work Exercise 2 independently and then compare answers with a neighbor. If needed, facilitate
agreement on the correct answer by allowing students to discuss their thought processes and justify their solutions.
Exercise 2
Multiply the polynomials using the distributive property: (𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟐𝟐 + 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏).
𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 (𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏) + 𝒙𝒙(𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏) − 𝟏𝟏(𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏)
Exercise 3
The expression 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟔𝟔𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 is the result of applying the distributive property to the expression 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 (𝟓𝟓 + 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙). It is also
the result of the applying the distributive property to 𝟐𝟐(𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 ) or to 𝒙𝒙(𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒙𝒙 + 𝟔𝟔𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 ), for example, or even to 𝟏𝟏 ∙
(𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟔𝟔𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 )!
For (i) to (x) below, write down an expression such that if you applied the distributive property to your expression it will
give the result presented. Give interesting answers!
i. 𝟔𝟔𝒂𝒂 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐
ii. 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 (𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙 + 𝒙𝒙𝟔𝟔 ) or 𝒙𝒙(𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 + 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 + 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟗𝟗 ) or 𝟐𝟐(𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 + 𝒙𝒙𝟓𝟓 + 𝒙𝒙𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 )
v. 𝒛𝒛𝟐𝟐 �(𝒂𝒂 + 𝒃𝒃) + 𝒛𝒛(𝒂𝒂 + 𝒃𝒃)� or 𝒛𝒛(𝒛𝒛(𝒂𝒂 + 𝒃𝒃) + 𝒛𝒛𝟐𝟐 (𝒂𝒂 + 𝒃𝒃))
𝟏𝟏
vi. (𝟑𝟑𝒔𝒔𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏)
𝟐𝟐
vii. 𝟑𝟑𝒑𝒑𝟐𝟐 𝒓𝒓𝟐𝟐 �𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝒓𝒓𝟐𝟐 − 𝟐𝟐𝒓𝒓𝟑𝟑 + 𝟑𝟑𝒑𝒑𝟐𝟐 + √𝟐𝟐𝒑𝒑𝒓𝒓𝟒𝟒 � or 𝒑𝒑𝟐𝟐 𝒓𝒓𝟐𝟐 (𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒓𝒓𝟐𝟐 − 𝟔𝟔𝒓𝒓𝟑𝟑 + 𝟗𝟗𝒑𝒑𝟐𝟐 + 𝟑𝟑√𝟐𝟐𝒑𝒑𝒓𝒓𝟒𝟒 )
𝟒𝟒 𝟖𝟖
viii. 𝟎𝟎. 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙𝟖𝟖 (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) or 𝒙𝒙 (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏)
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
Choose one (or more) to go through as a class, listing as many different re-writes as possible. Then remark:
The process of making use of the distributive property “backwards” is factoring.
Exercise 4 (5 minutes)
Exercise 4
Sammy wrote a polynomial using only one variable, 𝒙𝒙, of degree 𝟑𝟑. Myisha wrote a polynomial in the same variable of
degree 𝟓𝟓. What can you say about the degree of the product of Sammy’s and Myisha’s polynomials?
Extension
Extension
Find a polynomial that, when multiplied by 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏, gives the answer 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 + 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏.
𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏
Closing (6 minutes)
Is the product of two polynomials sure to be another polynomial?
Yes, by the definition of polynomial expression given in Lesson 8, the product of any two polynomial
expressions is again a polynomial expression, which can then be written in standard polynomial form
through application of the distributive property.
Is a polynomial squared sure to be another polynomial (other integer powers)?
Yes.
Exit Ticket
Yes.
𝒘𝒘𝟓𝟓 + 𝒘𝒘𝟐𝟐 − 𝒘𝒘 + 𝟏𝟏
1. Use the distributive property to write each of the following expressions as the sum of monomials.
𝟏𝟏
c. (𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒛𝒛 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒛𝒛𝟐𝟐 ) d. 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙(𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏)
𝟑𝟑
𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 − 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙
𝟔𝟔𝒛𝒛𝟐𝟐 + 𝟒𝟒𝒛𝒛
e. (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟒𝟒)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓) f. (𝟐𝟐𝒛𝒛 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝟑𝟑𝒛𝒛𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏)
𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙 + 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 𝟔𝟔𝒛𝒛𝟑𝟑 − 𝟑𝟑𝒛𝒛𝟐𝟐 + 𝟐𝟐𝒛𝒛 − 𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏
i. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒔𝒔𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 � 𝒔𝒔𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟎𝟎. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒔𝒔� j. (𝟐𝟐𝒒𝒒 + 𝟏𝟏)(𝟐𝟐𝒒𝒒𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏)
𝟐𝟐
𝟖𝟖𝒔𝒔𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟐𝟐𝒔𝒔𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟒𝟒𝒒𝒒𝟑𝟑 + 𝟐𝟐𝒒𝒒𝟐𝟐 + 𝟐𝟐𝒒𝒒 + 𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙+𝒚𝒚
q. r. (𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝒇𝒇𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒇𝒇𝟓𝟓 ) ÷ 𝟓𝟓
𝟑𝟑
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟒𝟒𝒇𝒇𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟐𝟐𝒇𝒇𝟓𝟓
𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚
𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑
(𝒂𝒂+𝒃𝒃−𝒄𝒄)(𝒂𝒂+𝒃𝒃+𝒄𝒄)
s. −𝟓𝟓𝒚𝒚(𝒚𝒚𝟐𝟐 + 𝒚𝒚 − 𝟐𝟐) − 𝟐𝟐(𝟐𝟐 − 𝒚𝒚𝟑𝟑 ) t.
𝟑𝟑 𝟐𝟐
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
−𝟑𝟑𝒚𝒚 − 𝟓𝟓𝒚𝒚 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒚𝒚 − 𝟒𝟒 𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐 𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐 𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
𝒂𝒂 + 𝒃𝒃 − 𝒄𝒄 + 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
u. (𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 ÷ 𝟗𝟗 + (𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙) ÷ 𝟐𝟐) ÷ (−𝟐𝟐) v. (−𝟐𝟐𝒇𝒇𝟑𝟑 − 𝟐𝟐𝒇𝒇 + 𝟏𝟏)(𝒇𝒇𝟐𝟐 − 𝒇𝒇 + 𝟐𝟐)
𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 −𝟐𝟐𝒇𝒇𝟓𝟓 + 𝟐𝟐𝒇𝒇𝟒𝟒 − 𝟔𝟔𝒇𝒇𝟑𝟑 + 𝟑𝟑𝒇𝒇𝟐𝟐 − 𝟓𝟓𝒇𝒇 + 𝟐𝟐
−
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
2. Use the distributive property (and your wits!) to write each of the following expressions as a sum of monomials. If
the resulting polynomial is in one variable, write the polynomial in standard form.
j. (𝟓𝟓 + 𝒒𝒒)𝟑𝟑
𝒒𝒒𝟑𝟑 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒒𝒒𝟐𝟐 + 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕𝒒𝒒 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
3. Use the distributive property (and your wits!) to write each of the following expressions as a polynomial in standard
form.
e. (𝒖𝒖 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒖𝒖𝟓𝟓 + 𝒖𝒖𝟒𝟒 + 𝒖𝒖𝟑𝟑 + 𝒖𝒖𝟐𝟐 + 𝒖𝒖 + 𝟏𝟏) f. √𝟓𝟓(𝒖𝒖 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒖𝒖𝟓𝟓 + 𝒖𝒖𝟒𝟒 + 𝒖𝒖𝟑𝟑 + 𝒖𝒖𝟐𝟐 + 𝒖𝒖 + 𝟏𝟏)
𝒖𝒖𝟔𝟔 − 𝟏𝟏 √𝟓𝟓𝒖𝒖𝟔𝟔 − √𝟓𝟓
4. Beatrice writes down every expression that appears in this problem set, one after the other, linking them with
“+” signs between them. She is left with one very large expression on her page. Is that expression a polynomial
expression? That is, is it algebraically equivalent to a polynomial?
Yes.
Yes.
Yes.
Name Date
1. Jacob lives on a street that runs east and west. The grocery store is to the east and the post office is to
the west of his house. Both are on the same street as his house. Answer the questions below about the
following story:
At 1: 00 p.m., Jacob hops in his car and drives at a constant speed of 25 mph for 6 minutes to the post
office. After 10 minutes at the post office, he realizes he is late and drives at a constant speed of 30 mph
to the grocery store, arriving at 1: 28 p.m. He then spends 20 minutes buying groceries.
a. Draw a graph that shows the distance Jacob’s car is from his house with respect to time. Remember
to label your axes with the units you chose and any important points (home, post office, grocery
store).
b. On the way to the grocery store, Jacob looks down at his watch and notes the time as he passes his
house. What time is it when he passes his house? Explain how you found your answer.
c. If he drives directly back to his house after the grocery story, what was the total distance he traveled
to complete his errands? Show how you found your answer.
2. Jason is collecting data on the rate of water usage in the tallest skyscraper in the world during a typical
day. The skyscraper contains both apartments and businesses. The electronic water meter for the
building displays the total amount of water used in liters. At noon, Jason looks at the water meter and
notes that the digit in the ones place on the water meter display changes too rapidly to read the digit and
that the digit in the tens place changes every second or so.
a. Estimate the total number of liters used in the building during one 24-hour day. Take into account
the time of day when he made his observation. (Hint: Will water be used at the same rate at 2: 00
a.m. as at noon?) Explain how you arrived at your estimate.
b. To what level of accuracy can Jason reasonably report a measurement if he takes it at precisely
12: 00 p.m.? Explain your answer.
c. The meter will be checked at regular time spans (for example, every minute, every 10 minutes, and
every hour). What is the minimum (or smallest) number of checks needed in a 24-hour period to
create a reasonably accurate graph of the water usage rate with respect to time? (For example, 24
checks would mean checking the meter every hour; 48 checks would mean checking the meter every
half hour.) Defend your choice by describing how the water usage rate might change during the day
and how your choice could capture that change.
3. A publishing company orders black and blue ink in bulk for its two-color printing press. To keep things
simple with its ink supplier, each time it places an order for blue ink, it buys 𝐵𝐵 gallons, and each time it
places an order for black ink, it buys 𝐾𝐾 gallons. Over a one-month period, the company places 𝑚𝑚 orders
of blue ink and 𝑛𝑛 orders of black ink.
a. What quantities could the following expressions represent in terms of the problem context?
𝑚𝑚 + 𝑛𝑛
𝑚𝑚𝑚𝑚 + 𝑛𝑛𝑛𝑛
𝑚𝑚𝑚𝑚 + 𝑛𝑛𝑛𝑛
𝑚𝑚 + 𝑛𝑛
b. The company placed twice as many orders for black ink than for blue ink in January. Give
interpretations for the following expressions in terms of the orders placed in January,
𝑚𝑚 𝑛𝑛
and ,
𝑚𝑚 + 𝑛𝑛 𝑚𝑚 + 𝑛𝑛
4. Sam says that he knows a clever set of steps to rewrite the expression
as a sum of two terms where the steps do not involve multiplying the linear factors first and then
collecting like terms. Rewrite the expression as a sum of two terms (where one term is a number and the
other is a product of a coefficient and variable) using Sam’s steps if you can.
5. Using only the addition and multiplication operations with the numbers 1, 2, 3, and 4 each exactly once,
it is possible to build a numeric expression (with parentheses to show the order used to build the
expression) that evaluates to 21. For example, 1 + ((2 + 3) · 4) is one such expression.
a. Build two more numeric expressions that evaluate to 21 using the criteria above. Both must be
different from the example given.
b. In both of your expressions, replace 1 with 𝑎𝑎, 2 with 𝑏𝑏, 3 with 𝑐𝑐, and 4 with 𝑑𝑑 to get two algebraic
expressions. For example, 𝑎𝑎 + �(𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐) · 𝑑𝑑� shows the replacements for the example given.
If they are equivalent, prove that they are using the properties of operations.
If not, provide two examples:
(1) Find four different numbers (other than 0, 1, 2, 3, 4) that when substituted for 𝑎𝑎, 𝑏𝑏, 𝑐𝑐,
and 𝑑𝑑 into each expression, the expressions evaluate to different numbers, and
(2) Find four different, non-zero numbers that when substituted into each expression, the
expressions evaluate to the same number.
6. The diagram below, when completed, shows all possible ways to build equivalent expressions of 3𝑥𝑥 2
using multiplication. The equivalent expressions are connected by labeled segments stating which
property of operations, A for associative property and C for commutative property, justifies why the two
expressions are equivalent. Answer the following questions about 3𝑥𝑥 2 and the diagram.
a. Fill in the empty circles with A or C and the empty rectangle with the missing expression to complete
the diagram.
b. Using the diagram above to help guide you, give two different proofs that (𝑥𝑥 ∙ 𝑥𝑥) ∙ 3 = (3 ∙ 𝑥𝑥) ∙ 𝑥𝑥.
7. Ahmed learned: “To multiply a whole number by ten, just place a zero at the end of the number.” For
example, 2813 × 10, he says, is 28,130. He doesn't understand why this “rule” is true.
a. What is the product of the polynomial, 2𝑥𝑥 3 + 8𝑥𝑥 2 + 𝑥𝑥 + 3, times the polynomial, 𝑥𝑥?
b. Use part (a) as a hint. Explain why the rule Ahmed learned is true.
8.
a. Find the following products:
i. (𝑥𝑥 − 1)(𝑥𝑥 + 1)
b. Substitute 𝑥𝑥 = 10 into each of the products from parts (i) through (iv) and your answers to show
how each of the products appears as a statement in arithmetic.
d. Multiply (𝑥𝑥 − 2) and (𝑥𝑥 7 + 𝑥𝑥 6 + 𝑥𝑥 5 + 𝑥𝑥 4 + 𝑥𝑥 3 + 𝑥𝑥 2 + 𝑥𝑥 + 1), and express your answer in standard
form.
Substitute 𝑥𝑥 = 10 into your answer, and see if you obtain the same result that you obtained in part
(c).
2 a Student left the Student either began Student answered Student answered
question blank. with an assumption beginning with the beginning with the
N-Q.A.3 OR that was not based on idea that water was idea that water was
Student provided an the evidence of water being used at a rate being used at a rate
answer that reflected being used at a rate of approximately 10 of approximately 10
no or very little of approximately 10 liters/second at noon liters/second at noon
reasoning. liters/second at noon. but made an error in and made correct
OR the calculations to calculations to extend
Student used poor extend and combine and combine that
reasoning in that rate to consider rate to consider usage
extending that usage across 24 across 24 hours.
reading to consider hours. AND
total use across 24 OR Student defended the
hours. Student did not choice by explaining
defend the choice by water usage across
explaining water the 24 hours and how
usage across the 24 it compares to the
hours and how it reading taken at
compares to the noon.
reading taken at
noon.
c Student left the Student answer was Student answer was Student answer was
question blank. not in the range of 6 in the range of 6 to in the range of 6 to 48
N-Q.A.3 OR to 48 checks but 48 checks but was checks, and student
Student provided an provided some only given in the form provided solid
answer that reflected reasoning to justify of 𝑥𝑥 checks per reasoning to support
no or very little the choice. minute or 𝑥𝑥 checks the answer.
reasoning. OR per hour; the answer
Student answer was was well supported
in that range, perhaps by a written
written in the form of explanation.
“every 𝑥𝑥 minutes” or OR
“every 𝑥𝑥 hours” but Student answer was
was not supported by given in terms of
an explanation with number of checks but
solid reasoning. was not well
supported by a
written explanation.
3 a Student either did not Student answered Student answered Student answered all
answer. one or two of the two of the three three correctly.
A-SSE.A.1a OR three correctly but correctly and made a
A-SSE.A.1b Student answered left the other one reasonable attempt
incorrectly for all blank or made a gross at describing what
three expressions. error in describing the other one
what it represented. represented.
b Student either did not Student understood Student understood Student understood
answer. that the expressions that the expressions that the expressions
A-SSE.A.1a OR represented a portion represented a portion represented a portion
A-SSE.A.1b Student answered of the orders for each of the orders for each of the orders for each
incorrectly for all color but mis- color and correctly color, correctly
three parts of the assigned the colors determined which determined which
question. and/or incorrectly one would be larger one would be larger,
4 A-SSE.A.1b Student left the Student got to the Student attempted to Student correctly
A-SSE.A.2 question blank. correct re-written use structure to re- used the process
OR expression of 8𝑥𝑥 + write the expression described to arrive at
Student was unable 24 but did so by as described, showing 8𝑥𝑥 + 24 without
to re-write the multiplying out the the process, but multiplying out linear
expression factors first OR did student made errors factors and
successfully, even by not show the work in the process. demonstrated the
multiplying out the needed to steps for doing so.
factors first. demonstrate how
8𝑥𝑥 + 24 was
determined.
5 a–b Student was unable Student was only able Student successfully Student answered all
to respond to many to come up with one answered part (a) and four parts correctly
A-SSE.A.2 of the questions. option for part (a) identified that the and completely.
OR and, therefore, had expressions created
Student left several only partial work for in part (b) were not
items blank. part (b). equivalent, but there
OR were minor errors in
Student answered the answering of the
“Yes” for the question remaining questions.
about equivalent
expressions.
6 a Student left at least Student answered Student completed Student completed all
three items blank. one or two items circling task correctly four item correctly,
A-SSE.A.2 OR incorrectly or left one and provided a including exact
Student answered at or more items blank. correct ordering of placement of
least three items symbols in the box, parentheses and
incorrectly. but the answer did symbols for the box:
not use parentheses 𝑥𝑥 ∙ (3 ∙ 𝑥𝑥).
or multiplication dots.
7 a Student left the Student made more Student made a Student multiplied
question blank or than one error in his minor error in the correctly and
A-APR.A.1 demonstrated no multiplication but multiplication. expressed the
understanding of demonstrated some resulting polynomial
multiplication of understanding of as a sum of
polynomials. multiplication of monomials.
polynomials.
b Student left the Student used Student made only Student made no
question blank or did language that did not minor errors in the errors in the use of
A-APR.A.1 not demonstrate a indicate an use of mathematically mathematically
level of thinking that understanding of correct language to correct language to
was higher than what base 𝑥𝑥 and/or the relate the new relate the new
was given in the place value system. number to the old in number to the old in
problem’s description Student may have terms of place value terms of place value
of Ahmed’s thinking. used language such as and/or the use of and/or the use of
shifting or moving. base 𝑥𝑥. base 𝑥𝑥.
8 a–c Student showed Student made Student made one or Student completed all
limited or no multiple errors but two minor errors but products correctly,
A-APR.A.1 understanding of showed some demonstrated expressing each as a
polynomial understanding of knowledge of sum of monomials
multiplication and of polynomial polynomial with like terms
evaluating a multiplication. multiplication and collected, and
polynomial for the Student may not have combining like terms evaluated correctly
given value of 𝑥𝑥. combined like terms to create the new when 𝑥𝑥 is 10.
to present the polynomial. Student
product as the sum of also showed
monomials. understanding of
evaluating a
polynomial for the
given value of 𝑥𝑥.
e Student was unable Student may have Student may have Student correctly
to demonstrate an made some errors as made minor errors in multiplied the
A-APR.A.1 understanding that he multiplied the multiplying the polynomials and
part (iii) is “No” polynomials and polynomials and expressed the
and/or demonstrated expressed the expressing the product as a sum of
limited or no product as a sum of product as a sum of monomials with like
understanding of monomials. Student monomials. Student terms collected.
polynomial may have made some may have made Student correctly
multiplication. errors in the minor errors in calculated the value
calculation of the calculating the value of the polynomial
value of the of the polynomial when 𝑥𝑥 is 10.
polynomial when 𝑥𝑥 is when 𝑥𝑥 is 10. Student explained
10. Student Student explained that the hypothesized
incorrectly answered that the hypothesized equation being true
part (iii) or applied equation being true when 𝑥𝑥 = 10 does
incorrect reasoning. when 𝑥𝑥 = 10 does not make it true for
not make it true for all real 𝑥𝑥 and/or
all real 𝑥𝑥 and/or explained that the
explained that the two expressions are
two expressions are not algebraically
not algebraically equivalent.
equivalent.
Name Date
1. Jacob lives on a street that runs east and west. The grocery store is to the east and the post office is to
the west of his house. Both are on the same street as his house. Answer the questions below about the
following story:
At 1: 00 p.m., Jacob hops in his car and drives at a constant speed of 25 mph for 6 minutes to the post
office. After 10 minutes at the post office, he realizes he is late, and drives at a constant speed of 30 mph
to the grocery store, arriving at 1: 28 p.m. He then spends 20 minutes buying groceries.
a. Draw a graph that shows the distance Jacob’s car is from his house with respect to time. Remember
to label your axes with the units you chose and any important points (home, post office, grocery
store).
miles hour
25 × 6 minutes × 1 = 2.5 miles from house to post office
hour 60 minutes
miles hour
30 × 12 minutes × 1 = 6 miles from post office to store
hour 60 minutes
b. On the way to the grocery store, Jacob looks down at his watch and notes the time as he passes his
house. What time is it when he passes his house? Explain how you found your answer.
It is 1:21. The graph shows the time as 21 minutes past 1:00 PM. He spent 6 minutes getting to
the post office, 10 minutes at the post office, and 5 minutes getting from the post office to the
point of passing by his house. You know it took 5 minutes for the last part because he traveled 30
60 minutes
miles per hour and went 2.5 miles. 2.5 miles × = 5 minutes
30 miles
c. If he drives directly back to his house after the grocery story, what was the total distance he traveled
to complete his errands? Show how you found your answer.
12 miles.
You know it is 25 miles from the house to the post office because
miles hour
25 × 6 minutes × 1 = 2.5 miles.
hour 60 minutes
miles hour
You know it is 6 miles from the post office to the store because 30 × 12 minutes × 1 =
hour 60 minutes
6 miles.
2. Jason is collecting data on the rate of water usage in the tallest skyscraper in the world during a typical
day. The skyscraper contains both apartments and businesses. The electronic water meter for the
building displays the total amount of water used in liters. At noon, Jason looks at the water meter and
notes that the digit in the ones place on the water meter display changes too rapidly to read the digit and
that the digit in the tens place changes every second or so.
a. Estimate the total number of liters used in the building during one 24-hour day. Take into account
the time of day when he made his observation. (Hint: Will water be used at the same rate at 2: 00
a.m. as at noon?) Explain how you arrived at your estimate.
Since water is probably only used from about 5:00 AM to 11:00 PM, I did not multiply by 24
b. To what level of accuracy can Jason reasonably report a measurement if he takes it at precisely
12: 00 p.m.? Explain your answer.
It can be reported within ±10 liters, since he can read the 10’s place, but it is changing by a 10
during the second he reads it.
c. The meter will be checked at regular time spans (for example, every minute, every 10 minutes, and
every hour). What is the minimum (or smallest) number of checks needed in a 24-hour period to
create a reasonably accurate graph of the water usage rate with respect to time? (For example, 24
checks would mean checking the meter every hour; 48 checks would mean checking the meter every
half hour.) Defend your choice by describing how the water usage rate might change during the day
and how your choice could capture that change.
24 checks. Every hour would be good to show the peaks in usage during morning and evening
hours from those in the apartments. And it might also show that businesses stop using it after
business hours. It would depend on what portion of the building is business vs. apartments.
3. A publishing company orders black and blue ink in bulk for its two-color printing press. To keep things
simple with its ink supplier, each time it places an order for blue ink, it buys 𝐵𝐵 gallons, and each time it
places an order for black ink, it buys 𝐾𝐾 gallons. Over a one-month period, the company places 𝑚𝑚 orders
of blue ink and 𝑛𝑛 orders of black ink.
a. What quantities could the following expressions represent in terms of the problem context?
mB + nK
- Average number of gallons of ink per order.
m+n
b. The company placed twice as many orders for black ink than for blue ink in January. Give
interpretations for the following expressions in terms of the orders placed in January,
𝑚𝑚 𝑛𝑛
and ,
𝑚𝑚+𝑛𝑛 𝑚𝑚+𝑛𝑛
n
is the fraction of orders that are for black ink.
m+n
n m
would be bigger, 2 times as big as because they ordered twice as many orders for
m+n m+n
4. Sam says that he knows a clever set of steps to rewrite the expression
as a sum of two terms where the steps do not involve multiplying the linear factors first and then
collecting like terms. Rewrite the expression as a sum of two terms (where one term is a number and the
other is a product of a coefficient and variable) using Sam’s steps if you can.
�(3x + 8) − 3x�∙(x + 3)
8(x + 3)
8x + 24
5. Using only the addition and multiplication operations with the numbers 1, 2, 3, and 4 each exactly once,
it is possible to build a numeric expression (with parentheses to show the order used to build the
expression) that evaluates to 21. For example, 1 + �(2 + 3) · 4� is one such expression.
a. Build two more numeric expressions that evaluate to 21 using the criteria above. Both must be
different from the example given.
(1 + 2) ∙ (3 + 4) = 21
�(2 + 4) + 1� ∙ 3 = 21
b. In both of your expressions, replace 1 with 𝑎𝑎, 2 with 𝑏𝑏, 3 with 𝑐𝑐, and 4 with 𝑑𝑑 to get two algebraic
expressions. For example, 𝑎𝑎 + �(𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐) · 𝑑𝑑� shows the replacements for the example given.
�a + b� ∙ (c + d) = ac + ad + bc + bd
��b + d� + a� ∙ c = ac + bc + dc
If they are equivalent, prove that they are using the properties of operations.
If not, provide two examples:
(1) Find four different numbers (other than 0, 1, 2, 3, 4) that when substituted for 𝑎𝑎, 𝑏𝑏, 𝑐𝑐,
and 𝑑𝑑 into each expression, the expressions evaluate to different numbers, and
a=5 b = 10 c = 20 d = 30
(2) Find four different, non-zero numbers that when substituted into each expression, the
expressions evaluate to the same number.
6. The diagram below, when completed, shows all possible ways to build equivalent expressions of
3𝑥𝑥 2 using multiplication. The equivalent expressions are connected by labeled segments stating which
property of operations, A for associative property and C for commutative property, justifies why the two
expressions are equivalent. Answer the following questions about 3𝑥𝑥 2 and the diagram.
A
C
a. Fill in the empty circles with A or C and the empty rectangle with the missing expression to complete
the diagram.
b. Using the diagram above to help guide you, give two different proofs that (𝑥𝑥 ∙ 𝑥𝑥) ∙ 3 = (3 ∙ 𝑥𝑥) ∙ 𝑥𝑥.
1. (x ∙ x) ∙ 3 = x ∙ (x ∙ 3) by Associate Property
x ∙ (x ∙ 3) = x ∙ (3 ∙ x) by Commutative Property
x ∙ (3 ∙ x) = (3 ∙ x) ∙ x by Commutative Property
2. (x ∙ x) ∙ 3 = 3 ∙ (x ∙ x) by Commutative Property
3 ∙ (x ∙ x) = (3 ∙ x) ∙ x by Associate Property
7. Ahmed learned: “To multiply a whole number by ten, just place a zero at the end of the number.” For
example, 2813 × 10, he says, is 28,130. He doesn't understand why this “rule” is true.
a. What is the product of the polynomial, 2𝑥𝑥 3 + 8𝑥𝑥 2 + 𝑥𝑥 + 3, times the polynomial, 𝑥𝑥?
2x4 + 8x3 + x2 + 3x
b. Use part (a) as a hint. Explain why the rule Ahmed learned is true.
When you multiply by the same number as the base, it creates a new number where each digit in the
original number is now one place-value higher so that there is nothing left (no numbers) to represent
the ones’ digit, which leads to a trailing “0” in the ones’ digit.
8.
a. Find the following products:
i. (𝑥𝑥 − 1)(𝑥𝑥 + 1)
x2 + x − x − 1
x2 -1
x3 + x2 + x − x2 − x − 1
x3 − 1
x4 + x3 + x2 + x − x3 − x2 − x − 1
x4 − 1
x5 + x4 + x3 + x2 + x − x4 − x3 − x2 − x − 1
x5 − 1
xn+1 − 1
b. Substitute 𝑥𝑥 = 10 into each of the products from parts (i) through (iv) and your answers to show
how each of the products appears as a statement in arithmetic.
8 ∙ (11,111,111) = 88,888,888
Substitute 𝑥𝑥 = 10 into your answer and see if you obtain the same result as you obtained in part (c).
108 − 107 − 106 − 105 − 104 − 103 − 102 − 10 − 2 = 88,888,888. Yes, I get the same answer.
Yes.
No, just because it is true when x is 10, doesn’t make it true for all real x. The two
Mathematics Curriculum
ALGEBRA I • MODULE 1
Topic C:
Solving Equations and Inequalities
A-CED.A.3, A-CED.A.4, A-REI.A.1, A-REI.B.3, A-REI.C.5, A-REI.C.6, A-REI.D.10, A-REI.D.12
Instructional Days: 15
Lesson 10: True and False Equations (P) 1
Lesson 11: Solution Sets for Equations and Inequalities (P)
Lesson 12: Solving Equations (P)
Lesson 13: Some Potential Dangers when Solving Equations (P)
Lesson 14: Solving Inequalities (P)
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And” or “Or” (E)
Lesson 16: Solving and Graphing Inequalities Joined by “And” or “Or” (P)
Lesson 17: Equations Involving Factored Expressions (S)
Lesson 18: Equations Involving a Variable Expression in the Denominator (P)
Lesson 19: Rearranging Formulas (P)
Lessons 20: Solution Sets to Equations with Two Variables (P)
Lessons 21: Solution Sets to Inequalities with Two Variables (P)
Lessons 22–23: Solution Sets to Simultaneous Equations (P, E)
Lesson 24: Applications of Systems of Equations and Inequalities (E)
Teaching the process of how to solve an equation is fraught with well-meaning models and procedures
suggested by textbook curricula (balance scales, algebra tiles, equivalent equations, etc.) that are often
incompatible with what it actually means “to solve.” An equation with variables can be viewed as a question
asking for which values of the variables (the solution set) will result in true number sentences when those
values are substituted into the equation. Equations are manifestly about numbers and understanding true
and false number sentences. In Algebra I, the application of this idea expands to include solutions to
compound statements such as equations or inequalities joined by “and” or “or,” including simultaneous
systems of equations or inequalities.
The Common Core Learning Standards rightfully downplay the notion of equivalent equations and instead
place a heavy emphasis on students studying the solution sets to equations. In Lessons 12–14 of this topic,
students formalize descriptions of what they learned before (true/false equations, solution sets, identities,
properties of equality, etc.) and learn how to explain the steps of solving equations to construct viable
arguments to justify their solution methods. They then learn methods for solving inequalities, again by
focusing on ways to preserve the (now infinite) solution sets. With these methods now on firm footing,
students investigate in Lessons 15–18 solution sets of equations joined by “and” or “or” and investigate ways
to change an equation such as squaring both sides, which changes the solution set in a controlled (and often
useful) way. In Lesson 19, students learn to use these same skills as they rearrange formulas to define one
quantity in terms of another. Finally, in Lessons 20–24, students apply all of these new skills and
understandings as they work through solving equations and inequalities with two variables including systems
of such equations and inequalities.
1 Lesson Structure Key: P-Problem Set Lesson, M-Modeling Cycle Lesson, E-Exploration Lesson, S-Socratic Lesson
Student Outcomes
Students understand that an equation is a statement of equality between two expressions. When values are
substituted for the variables in an equation, the equation is either true or false. Students find values to assign
to the variables in equations that make the equations true statements.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (5 minutes)
Give students a few minutes to reflect on Exercise 1. Then ask students to share their initial reactions and thoughts in
answering the questions.
Exercise 1
a. Consider the statement: “The President of the United States is a United States citizen.”
Is the statement a grammatically correct sentence?
What is the subject of the sentence? What is the verb in the sentence?
Is the sentence true?
Hold a general class discussion about parts (c) and (d) of the exercise. Be sure to raise the following points:
One often hears the chime that “Mathematics is a language.” And indeed it is. For us reading this text, that
language is English. (And if this text were written in French, that language would be French, or if this text were
written in Korean, that language would be Korean.)
A mathematical statement, such as 2 + 3 = 1 + 4, is a grammatically correct sentence. The subject of the
sentence is the numerical expression “2 + 3”, and its verb is “equals” or “is equal to.” The numerical
expression “1 + 4” renames the subject (2 + 3). We say that the statement is TRUE because these two
numerical expressions evaluate to the same numerical value (namely, five).
The mathematical statement 2 + 3 = 9 + 4 is also a grammatically correct sentence, but we say it is FALSE
because the numerical expression to the left (the subject of the sentence) and the numerical expression to the
right do not evaluate to the same numerical value.
(Perhaps remind students of parts (a) and (b) of the exercise: grammatically correct sentences can be false.)
A number sentence is said to be true if both numerical expressions are equivalent (that is, both evaluate to the same
number). It is said to be false otherwise. True and false are called truth values.
Exercise 2 (7 minutes)
Have students complete this exercise independently, and then review the answers as a class.
Exercise 2
a. 𝟒𝟒 + 𝟖𝟖 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝟓𝟓
FALSE
𝟏𝟏 𝟓𝟓
b. + = 𝟏𝟏. 𝟐𝟐 − 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎
𝟐𝟐 𝟖𝟖
TRUE
FALSE
f. 𝝅𝝅 = 𝟑𝟑. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
FALSE (The value of 𝝅𝝅 is not exactly 𝟑𝟑. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.)
FALSE
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐
h. + =
𝟐𝟐 𝟑𝟑 𝟓𝟓
FALSE
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐
i. + =
𝟐𝟐 𝟑𝟑 𝟔𝟔
FALSE
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟓𝟓
j. + =
𝟐𝟐 𝟑𝟑 𝟔𝟔
TRUE
Exercise 3 (3 minutes)
Allow students to answer the questions in their student materials, and then discuss with the class.
Exercise 3
A number sentence has a left-hand numerical expression that evaluates to a single number and has a right-
hand numerical expression that also evaluates to a single numerical value. Either these two single values
match or they do not. A numerical sentence is thus either TRUE or FALSE (and not both).
Algebraic equations can be number sentences (when both expressions are numerical), but often they contain
symbols whose values have not been determined.
Exercise 4 (6 minutes)
Exercise 4
Numbers (ii), (iii), (iv), and (v). (Note that the symbol 𝝅𝝅 has a value that has is already stated or known.)
c. For each number sentence, state whether the number sentence is true or false.
(ii) False, (iii) True, (iv) False, (v) False. Note that (ii) and (v) are both very close to evaluating to true. Some
calculators may not be able to discern the difference. Wolfram Alpha’s web-based application can be used to
reveal the differences.
Exercise 5 (9 minutes)
Discuss the three cases for algebraic equations given in the student materials, and based on the preparedness of your
students, complete the exercise as a whole class, in small groups, in pairs, or individually.
Exercise 5
When algebraic equations contain a symbol whose value has not yet been determined, we use analysis to determine
whether:
1. The equation is true for all the possible values of the variable(s), or
2. The equation is true for a certain set of the possible value(s) of the variable(s), or
3. The equation is never true for any of the possible values of the variable(s).
For each of the three cases, write an algebraic equation that would be correctly described by that case. Use only the
variable, 𝒙𝒙, where 𝒙𝒙 represents a real number.
1. 𝟐𝟐(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟔𝟔; By the distributive property, the two expressions on each side of the equal sign are
algebraically equivalent; therefore, the equation is true for all possible real numbers, 𝒙𝒙.
2. 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏; This equation is only a true number sentence if 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟔𝟔. Any other real number would make the
equation a false number sentence.
3. 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 = −𝟏𝟏; There is no real number 𝒙𝒙 that could make this equation a true number sentence.
Example 1 (4 minutes)
Example 1
Julie is 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 feet away from her friend’s front porch and observes, “Someone is sitting on the porch.”
Given that she didn’t specify otherwise, we would assume that the “someone” Julie thinks she sees is a human. We can’t
guarantee that Julie’s observatory statement is true. It could be that Julie’s friend has something on the porch that
merely looks like a human from far away. Julie assumes she is correct and moves closer to see if she can figure out who it
is. As she nears the porch she declares, “Ah, it is our friend, John Berry.”
Often in mathematics, we observe a situation and make a statement we believe to true. Just as Julie used the
word “someone”, in mathematics we use variables in our statements to represent quantities not yet known.
Then, just as Julie did, we “get closer” to study the situation more carefully and find out if our “someone”
exists and if so “who” it is.
Notice that we are comfortable assuming that the “someone” Julie referred to is a human, even though she
didn’t say so. In mathematics we have a similar assumption. If it is not stated otherwise, we assume that
variable symbols represent a real number. But in some cases, we might say the variable represents an integer
or an even integer or a positive integer, for example.
Stating what type of number the variable symbol represents is called stating its domain.
Exercise 6 (6 minutes)
In the sentence 𝑤𝑤 2 = 4, 𝑤𝑤 can represent any real number we care to choose (its domain). If we choose to let 𝑤𝑤
be 5, then the number sentence is false. If we let 𝑤𝑤 = 2, then the sentence is true. Is there another value for
𝑤𝑤 that would also make the sentence true?
𝑤𝑤 = −2
Exercise 6
Name a value of the variable that would make each equation a true number sentence.
Here are several examples of how we can name the value of the variable:
There might be more than one option for what numerical values to write. (And feel free to write more than one
possibility.)
Warning: Some of these are tricky. Keep your wits about you!
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟓𝟓
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
b. Let _____________. Then 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓 = is true.
𝟐𝟐
𝒓𝒓 = 𝟔𝟔
𝒎𝒎 = −𝟓𝟓
d. A number 𝒙𝒙 and its square, 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 , have the same value when _________________.
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏 or when 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟎𝟎.
𝒏𝒏 = −𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐.
There is no value one can assign to 𝒒𝒒 to turn this equation into a true statement.
Exit Ticket
1. Consider the following equation, where 𝑎𝑎 represents a real number: √𝑎𝑎 + 1 = √𝑎𝑎 + 1.
2. Suppose we are told that 𝑏𝑏 has the value 4. Can we determine whether the equation below is TRUE or FALSE? If so,
say which it is; if not, state that it cannot be determined. Justify your answer.
√𝑏𝑏 + 1 = √𝑏𝑏 + 1
√𝑐𝑐 + 1 = √𝑐𝑐 + 1
1. Consider the following equation, where 𝒂𝒂 represents a real number: √𝒂𝒂 + 𝟏𝟏 = √𝒂𝒂 + 𝟏𝟏.
Is this statement a number sentence? If so, is the sentence TRUE or FALSE?
No, it is not a number sentence because no value has been assigned to 𝒂𝒂. Thus, it is neither TRUE nor FALSE.
2. Suppose we are told that 𝒃𝒃 has the value 𝟒𝟒. Can we determine whether the equation below is TRUE or FALSE? If so,
say which it is; if not, state that it cannot be determined. Justify your answer.
√𝒃𝒃 + 𝟏𝟏 = √𝒃𝒃 + 𝟏𝟏
FALSE, the left-hand expression has value √𝟒𝟒 + 𝟏𝟏 = √𝟓𝟓 and the right-hand expression has value 𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏 = 𝟑𝟑. These
are not the same value.
𝟒𝟒
4. 𝟓𝟓𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟐𝟐 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟐𝟐 5. (𝟐𝟐 × 𝟐𝟐)𝟐𝟐 = √𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 6. = 𝟏𝟏. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝟑𝟑
TRUE TRUE FALSE
𝟐𝟐
In the following equations, let 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟑𝟑 and 𝒚𝒚 = . Determine whether the following equations are true, false, or neither
𝟑𝟑
true nor false.
𝟐𝟐
10. 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 = −𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝒚𝒚 −𝒙𝒙
11. = −𝟐𝟐 12. = −𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 𝒚𝒚
TRUE
FALSE FALSE
For each of the following, assign a value to the variable, 𝒙𝒙, to make the equation a true statement.
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟑𝟑 or 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟔𝟔
𝒅𝒅 = 𝟏𝟏 or 𝒅𝒅 = −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏+𝒙𝒙 𝟑𝟑
17. = for _________________.
𝟏𝟏+𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 𝟓𝟓
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐 works.
𝟏𝟏+𝒙𝒙 𝟐𝟐
18. = for _________________.
𝟏𝟏+𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 𝟓𝟓
𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟑𝟑 works. So does 𝒙𝒙 = −
𝟐𝟐
19. The diagonal of a square of side length 𝑳𝑳 is 𝟐𝟐 inches long when _________________.
𝑳𝑳 = √𝟐𝟐 inches
𝟐𝟐
20. �𝑻𝑻 − √𝟑𝟑� = 𝑻𝑻𝟐𝟐 + 𝟑𝟑 for _________________.
𝑻𝑻 = 𝟎𝟎
𝟏𝟏 𝒙𝒙
21. = if _________________.
𝒙𝒙 𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏 and also if 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟏𝟏
𝒓𝒓 = −𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
26. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 27. = 28. =−
𝒃𝒃−𝟐𝟐 𝟒𝟒 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐−𝟐𝟐 𝟒𝟒
for 𝒕𝒕 = 𝟐𝟐 for 𝒃𝒃 = 𝟔𝟔 for 𝒃𝒃 = −𝟏𝟏
29. √𝒙𝒙 + √𝟓𝟓 = √𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓 30. (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑)𝟐𝟐 = 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + (−𝟑𝟑)𝟐𝟐 31. 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 = −𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
for 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟎𝟎 for 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟎𝟎 No real number will make the
equation true.
𝟐𝟐 𝟏𝟏 𝟑𝟑
32. + =
𝟑𝟑 𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙
𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
for 𝒙𝒙 =
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
Fill in the blank with a variable term so that the given value of the variable will make the equation true.
Fill in the blank with a constant term so that the given value of the variable will make the equation true.
37. 𝒓𝒓 + 𝟎𝟎 = 𝒓𝒓; 𝒓𝒓 is any real number 38. 𝒓𝒓 × 𝟏𝟏 = 𝒓𝒓; 𝒓𝒓 is any real number
39. An equation that is always true 40. An equation that is true when 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟎𝟎
41. An equation that is never true 42. An equation that is true when 𝒕𝒕 = 𝟏𝟏 or 𝒕𝒕 = −𝟏𝟏
43. An equation that is true when 𝒚𝒚 = −𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓 44. An equation that is true when 𝒛𝒛 = 𝝅𝝅
Student Outcomes
Students understand that an equation with variables is often viewed as a question asking for the set of values
one can assign to the variables of the equation to make the equation a true statement. They see the equation
as a “filter” that sifts through all numbers in the domain of the variables, sorting those numbers into two
disjoint sets: the solution set and the set of numbers for which the equation is false.
Students understand the commutative, associate, and distributive properties as identities; e.g., equations
whose solution sets are the set of all values in the domain of the variables.
Classwork
Example 1 (2 minutes)
Consider the equation shown in Example 1 of your student materials, 𝑥𝑥 2 = 3𝑥𝑥 + 4, where 𝑥𝑥 represents a real
number.
Since we have not stated the value of 𝑥𝑥, this is not a number sentence.
Example 1
Consider the equation, 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 = 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙 + 𝟒𝟒, where 𝒙𝒙 represents a real number.
No.
Then we cannot guarantee there will be any real value of 𝑥𝑥 that will make the equation true.
b. The following table shows how we might “sift” through various values to assign to the variable symbol 𝒙𝒙 in
the hunt for values that would make the equation true.
Of course, we should sift through ALL the real numbers if we are seeking all values that make the equation
𝑥𝑥 2 = 3𝑥𝑥 + 4 true. (This makes for quite a large table!) So far we have found that setting 𝑥𝑥 equal to 4 yields a
true statement.
Look at the image in your student materials. Can you see what is happening here and how it relates to what
we have been discussing?
The numbers are going down the road and being accepted into the solution set or rejected based on
whether or not the equation is true.
There happens to be just one more value we can assign to x that makes 𝑥𝑥 2 = 3𝑥𝑥 + 4 a true statement. Would
you like to continue the search to find it?
𝑥𝑥 = −1
Example 2 (1 minute)
Example 2
Here's a table that could be used to hunt for the value(s) of 𝑝𝑝 that make the equation true:
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
Let 𝒑𝒑 = 𝟕𝟕 + = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 FALSE
𝝅𝝅 𝝅𝝅
Let 𝒑𝒑 = 𝟓𝟓 𝟕𝟕 + 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 TRUE
But is a table necessary for this question? Is it obvious what value(s) we could assign to 𝑝𝑝 to make the
equation true?
Discussion (2 minutes)
The solution set of an equation written with only one variable is the set of all values one can assign to that variable to
make the equation a true statement. Any one of those values is said to be a solution to the equation.
To solve an equation means to find the solution set for that equation.
Recall that it is usually assumed that one is sifting through all the real numbers to find the solutions to an
equation, but a question or a situation might restrict the domain of values we should sift through. We might
be required to sift only through integer values, the positive real numbers, or the non-zero real numbers, for
example. The context of the question should make this clear.
Example 3 (1 minute)
Give students 1 minute or less to complete the exercise and then discuss the answer.
Example 3
We know that setting 𝒂𝒂 = 𝟓𝟓 or setting 𝒂𝒂 = −𝟓𝟓 makes 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 a true statement. And a little thought shows that these
are the only two values we can assign to make this so. The solution set is just the set containing the numbers 𝟓𝟓 and −𝟓𝟓.
(And since the question made no mention of restricting the domain of values we should consider, we shall assume both
these values are admissible solutions for this question.)
Discussion (6 minutes)
IN WORDS: 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 has solutions 𝟓𝟓 and −𝟓𝟓. (That is, 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 is true when 𝒂𝒂 = 𝟓𝟓 or 𝒂𝒂 = −𝟓𝟓.)
In this graphical representation, a solid dot is used to indicate a point on the number line that is to be included in the
solution set. (WARNING: The dot one physically draws is larger than the point it represents. One hopes that it is clear
from the context of the diagram which point each dot refers to.)
The curly brackets { } indicate we are denoting a set. A set is essentially a collection of things, e.g., letters,
numbers, cars, people. In this case, the things are numbers.
From this example, the numbers −𝟓𝟓 and 𝟓𝟓 are called elements of the set. No other elements belong in this
particular set because no other numbers make the equation 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 true.
Sometimes, a set is empty; it has no elements. In which case, the set looks like { }. We often denote this with
the symbol, ∅. We refer to this as the empty set or the null set.
Exercise 1 (3 minutes)
Allow students to work independently, making sense of the problem and persevering in solving it. Have the students
discuss the problem and its solution. As much as possible, let the students find the way to the solution and articulate
how they know on their own, interjecting questions as needed to spawn more conversation.
Exercise 1
MP.1 Solve for 𝒂𝒂: 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = −𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. Present the solution set in words, in set notation, and graphically.
IN WORDS: The solution set to this equation is the empty set. There are no real values to assign to 𝒂𝒂 to make the
equation true.
Exercise 2
Exercise 2
Depict the solution set of 𝟕𝟕 + 𝒑𝒑 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 in words, in set notation, and graphically.
IN A GRAPHICAL REPRESENTATION:
Example 4 (4 minutes)
Example 4
𝒙𝒙
Solve = 𝟏𝟏 for 𝒙𝒙, over the set of positive real numbers. Depict the solution set in words, in set notation, and graphically.
𝒙𝒙
The question statement indicates that we are to consider assigning values to 𝑥𝑥 only from the set of positive
real numbers. Let’s create a table to get a feel for the problem. (It might actually be helpful this time.)
It seems that each and every positive real number is a solution to this equation.
IN WORDS: The solution set is the set of all positive real numbers.
IN SET NOTATION: This is {𝑥𝑥 real | 𝑥𝑥 > 0}.
IN A GRAPHICAL REPRESENTATION:
Discussion (4 minutes)
Some comments on set notation:
If it is possible to list the elements in a set, then one might do so, for example:
{−3, 5, √40} is the set containing the three real numbers −3, 5, and √40.
{1, 2, 3, … , 10} is the set containing the ten integers 1 through 10. (The ellipsis is used to state that the
pattern suggested continues.)
If it is not possible or not easy to list the elements in a set, then use the notation:
{ variable symbol number type | a description }
For example:
{𝑥𝑥 real | 𝑥𝑥 > 0} reads as, “The set of all real numbers that are greater than zero.”
{𝑝𝑝 integer | −3 ≤ 𝑝𝑝 < 100} reads as, “The set of all integers that are greater than or equal to −3 and smaller
than 100.”
{𝑦𝑦 real | 𝑦𝑦 ≠ 0} reads as, “The set of all real numbers that are not equal to zero.”
The vertical bar “|” in this notation is often read as “that” or “such that.”
Exercise 3 (3 minutes)
Exercise 3
𝒙𝒙
Solve = 𝟏𝟏 for 𝒙𝒙, over the set of all non-zero real numbers. Describe the solution set in words, in set notation, and
𝒙𝒙
graphically.
IN WORDS: The solution set is the set of all non-zero real numbers.
IN A GRAPHICAL REPRESENTATION:
Example 5 (4 minutes)
Note that the following example is important to discuss with care.
Example 5
Since it is not specified otherwise, we should again assume that we are considering solutions from the set of all
real numbers.
In drawing a table to sift for possible solutions, students might come to suspect that every real value for 𝑥𝑥 is a
solution to this equation.
The distributive property states that, for all real numbers 𝑎𝑎, 𝑏𝑏, and 𝑐𝑐, the expressions 𝑎𝑎(𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐) and 𝑎𝑎𝑎𝑎 + 𝑎𝑎𝑐𝑐
are sure to have the same numerical value. The commutative property for multiplication states for all real
numbers 𝑑𝑑 and 𝑒𝑒, the expressions 𝑑𝑑𝑑𝑑 and 𝑒𝑒𝑒𝑒 have the same numerical value.
Consequently, we can say, for any value we assign to 𝑥𝑥:
𝑥𝑥(3 + 𝑥𝑥) = 𝑥𝑥 ⋅ 3 + 𝑥𝑥 2 ,
that is, 𝑥𝑥(3 + 𝑥𝑥) = 3𝑥𝑥 + 𝑥𝑥 2 is sure to be a true numerical statement. This proves that the solution set to this
equation is the set of all real numbers.
It is awkward to express the set of all real numbers in set notation. We simply write the “blackboard script” ℝ
for the set of all real numbers. (By hand, one usually just draws a double vertical bar in the capital letter: .)
Exercise 4 (2 minutes)
Exercise 4
Solve for 𝜶𝜶: 𝛂𝛂 + 𝛂𝛂𝟐𝟐 = 𝛂𝛂(𝛂𝛂 + 𝟏𝟏). Describe carefully the reasoning that justifies your solution. Describe the solution set in
words, in set notation, and graphically.
IN WORDS: By the distributive property, we have 𝜶𝜶 + 𝜶𝜶𝟐𝟐 = 𝜶𝜶(𝟏𝟏 + 𝜶𝜶). This is a true numerical statement no matter what
value we assign to α. By the commutative property of addition, we have 𝜶𝜶 + 𝜶𝜶𝟐𝟐 = 𝜶𝜶(𝜶𝜶 + 𝟏𝟏), which is a true numerical
MP.3 statement no matter what real value we assign to α.
IN GRAPHICAL REPRESENTATION:
Discussion (2 minutes)
Recall, what does it mean for two expressions to be algebraically equivalent?
One expression can be converted to the other by repeatedly applying the commutative, associative, and
distributive properties or the properties of rational exponents to either expression.
When the left side of an equation is algebraically equivalent to the right side of an equation, what will the
solution set be?
All real numbers.
Exercise 5 (1 minute)
Exercise 5
Identify the properties of arithmetic that justify why each of the following equations has a solution set of all real
numbers:
Exercise 6 (2 minutes)
Exercise 6
Create an expression for the right side of each equation such that the solution set for the equation will be all real
numbers. (There is more than one possibility for each expression. Feel free to write several answers for each one.)
a. 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟓𝟓 =
b. 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝒙𝒙 =
c. 𝟒𝟒 · 𝒙𝒙 · 𝒚𝒚 · 𝒛𝒛 =
d. (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐)𝟐𝟐 =
𝟓𝟓
Sample Answers: (a) −𝟓𝟓 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 or 𝟐𝟐 �𝒙𝒙 − � (b) 𝒙𝒙 + 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 or 𝒙𝒙(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏) or 𝒙𝒙(𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙)
𝟐𝟐
(c) any rearranging of the factors (d) (𝟐𝟐 + 𝒙𝒙)𝟐𝟐 or 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝟒𝟒
Example 6
Have students describe the solution set to 𝑤𝑤 + 2 > 4 in words, in set notation, and in graphical representation.
IN GRAPHICAL REPRESENTATION:
Exercise 7
a. Solve for 𝑩𝑩: 𝑩𝑩𝟐𝟐 ≥ 𝟗𝟗. Describe the solution set using a number line.
b. What is the solution set to the statement: “Sticks of lengths 𝟐𝟐 yards, 𝟐𝟐 yards, and 𝑳𝑳 yards make an isosceles
triangle”? Describe the solution set in words and on a number line.
Lesson Summary
The solution set of an equation written with only one variable symbol is the set of all values one can assign to that
variable to make the equation a true number sentence. Any one of those values is said to be a solution to the
equation.
To solve an equation means to find the solution set for that equation.
IN WORDS: 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 has solutions 𝟓𝟓 and −𝟓𝟓. (That is, 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 is true when 𝒂𝒂 = 𝟓𝟓 or 𝒂𝒂 = −𝟓𝟓.)
It is awkward to express the set of infinitely many numbers in set notation. In these cases we can use the
notation: {variable symbol number type | a description}. For example {𝒙𝒙 real | 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟎𝟎} reads, “𝒙𝒙 is a real number
where 𝒙𝒙 is greater than zero.” The symbol ℝ can be used to indicate all real numbers.
IN A GRAPHICAL REPRESENTAION ON A NUMBER LINE: The solution set of 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 is as follows:
In this graphical representation, a solid dot is used to indicate a point on the number line that is to be included in
the solution set. (WARNING: The dot one physically draws is larger than the point it represents! One hopes that it
is clear from the context of the diagram which point each dot refers to.)
Exit Ticket
c. Write an equation or an inequality that has the set above as its solution set.
2. Indicate whether each of the following equations is sure to have a solution set of all real numbers. Explain your
answers for each.
a. 3(𝑥𝑥 + 1) = 3𝑥𝑥 + 1
b. 𝑥𝑥 + 2 = 2 + 𝑥𝑥
d. 3𝑥𝑥(4𝑥𝑥)(2𝑥𝑥) = 72𝑥𝑥 3
c. Write an equation or an inequality that has the set above as its solution set.
2. Indicate whether each of the following equations is sure to have a solution set of all real numbers. Explain your
answers for each.
a. 𝟑𝟑(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏) = 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏
No, the two algebraic expressions are not equivalent.
b. 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐 + 𝒙𝒙
Yes, the two expressions are algebraically equivalent by application of the commutative property.
d. 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙(𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙)(𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙) = 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑
No, the two algebraic expressions are not equivalent.
1. 2.
𝟐𝟐
a. the set of all real numbers equal to 𝟓𝟓 a. the set of all real numbers equal to
𝟑𝟑
𝟐𝟐
b. {𝟓𝟓} b. �𝟑𝟑�
c. answers vary c. answers vary
3. 4.
a. the set of all real numbers greater than 𝟏𝟏 a. the set of all real numbers less or equal to 𝟓𝟓
5. 6.
a. the set of all real numbers not equal to 𝟐𝟐 a. the set of all real numbers not equal to 𝟒𝟒
7. 8.
b. { } or ∅ b. {ℝ.}
For Problems 19–24, answer the following: Are the two expressions algebraically equivalent? If so, state the property (or
properties) displayed. If not, state why (the solution set may suffice as a reason) and change the equation, ever so
slightly, e.g., touch it up, to create an equation whose solution set is all real numbers.
𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙
20. = 𝟏𝟏
𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
No, the solution set is {𝒙𝒙 real | 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟎𝟎}. If we changed it to = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, it would have a solution set of all real numbers.
𝟏𝟏
21. (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐) + (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟓𝟓) = (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑)
Yes, distributive
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙
22. + =
𝟓𝟓 𝟑𝟑 𝟖𝟖
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖
No, the solution set is {𝟎𝟎}. If we changed it to + = , it would have a solution set of all real numbers.
𝟓𝟓 𝟑𝟑 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔+𝟏𝟏
25. Solve for 𝒘𝒘: ≠ 𝟐𝟐. Describe the solution set in set notation.
𝟓𝟓
𝟏𝟏
�𝒘𝒘 real | 𝒘𝒘 ≠ 𝟏𝟏 �
𝟐𝟐
26. Edwina has two sticks, one 𝟐𝟐 yards long and the other 𝟐𝟐 meters long. She is going to use them, with a third stick of
some positive length, to make a triangle. She has decided to measure the length of the third stick in units of feet.
a. What is the solution set to the statement: “Sticks of lengths 𝟐𝟐 yards, 𝟐𝟐 meters, and 𝑳𝑳 feet make a triangle”?
Describe the solution set in words and through a graphical representation.
One meter is equivalent, to two decimal places, to 𝟑𝟑. 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 feet. We have that 𝑳𝑳 must be a positive length
greater than 𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 feet and less than 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 feet. Within these values, the sum of any two sides will be
greater than the third side.
b. What is the solution set to the statement: “Sticks of lengths 𝟐𝟐 yards, 𝟐𝟐 meters, and 𝑳𝑳 feet make an isosceles
triangle”? Describe the solution set in words and through a graphical representation.
c. What is the solution set to the statement: “Sticks of lengths 𝟐𝟐 yards, 𝟐𝟐 meters, and 𝑳𝑳 feet make an
equilateral triangle”? Describe the solution set in words and through a graphical representation.
Student Outcomes
Students are introduced to the formal process of solving an equation: starting from the assumption that the
original equation has a solution. Students explain each step as following from the properties of equality.
Students identify equations that have the same solution set.
Classwork
Opening Exercise (4 minutes)
Opening Exercise
a. Why should the equations (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙 and (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 have the same solution
set?
b. Why should the equations (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙 and (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑)(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏) = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙 have the same solution
set?
c. Do you think the equations (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙 and (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) + 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 = 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 + 𝒙𝒙 should have the
same solution set? Why?
d. Do you think the equations (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙 and 𝟑𝟑(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) = 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 + 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 should have the same
solution set? Explain why.
Discussion (4 minutes)
Allow students to attempt to justify their answers for (a) and (b) above. Then summarize with the following:
We know that the commutative and associative properties hold for all real numbers. We also know that
variables are placeholders for real numbers, and the value(s) assigned to a variable that make an equation true
is the “solution.” If we apply the commutative and associative properties of real numbers to an expression, we
obtain an equivalent expression. Therefore, equations created this way (by applying the commutative and
associative properties to one or both expressions) consist of expressions equivalent to those in the original
equation.
In other words, if 𝑥𝑥 is a solution to an equation, then it will also be a solution to any new equation we make by
applying the commutative and associative properties to the expression in that equation.
Exercise 1 (3 minutes)
Exercise 1
a. Use the commutative property to write an equation that has the same solution set as
𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟒𝟒 = (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟕𝟕)(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏)(𝟓𝟓).
b. Use the associative property to write an equation that has the same solution set as
𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟒𝟒 = (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟕𝟕)(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏)(𝟓𝟓).
(x 2 − 3x) + 4 = �(x + 7)(x − 12)�(5)
Discussion (3 minutes)
Parts (c) and (d) of the Opening Exercise rely on key properties of equality. What are they?
Call on students to articulate and compare their thoughts as a class discussion. In middle school, these properties are
simply referred to as the if-then moves. Introduce their formal names to the class, the additive and multiplicative
properties of equality. Summarize with the following as you write it on the board:
So, whenever 𝑎𝑎 = 𝑏𝑏 is true, then 𝑎𝑎 + 𝑐𝑐 = 𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐 will also be true for all real numbers 𝑐𝑐.
What if 𝑎𝑎 = 𝑏𝑏 is false?
Then 𝑎𝑎 + 𝑐𝑐 = 𝑏𝑏 + 𝑐𝑐 will also be false.
Is it also ok, to subtract a number from both sides of the equation?
Yes, this is the same operation as adding the opposite of that number.
Whenever 𝑎𝑎 = 𝑏𝑏 is true, then 𝑎𝑎𝑎𝑎 = 𝑏𝑏𝑏𝑏 will also be true, and whenever 𝑎𝑎 = 𝑏𝑏 is false, 𝑎𝑎𝑎𝑎 = 𝑏𝑏𝑏𝑏 will also be false
for all non-zero real numbers 𝑐𝑐.
So, we have said earlier that applying the distributive, associative, and commutative properties does not change
the solution set, and now we see that applying the additive and multiplicative properties of equality also
preserves the solution set (does not change it).
Suppose I see the equation |𝑥𝑥| + 5 = 2. (Write the equation on the board.)
Is it true, then, that |𝑥𝑥| + 5 − 5 = 2 − 5? (Write the equation on the board.)
Allow students to verbalize their answer and challenge each other if they disagree. If they all say, “yes”, prompt
students with, “Are you sure?” until one or more students articulate that we would get the false statement: |𝑥𝑥| = −3.
Then summarize with the following points. Give these points great emphasis, perhaps adding grand gestures or voice
MP.1 inflection to recognize the importance of this moment, as it addresses a major part of A-REI.A.1:
So our idea that adding the same number to both sides gives us another true statement depends on the idea
that the first equation has a value of 𝑥𝑥 that makes it true to begin with.
It is a big assumption that we make when we start to solve equations using properties of equality. We are
assuming there is some value for the variable that makes the equation true. IF there is, then it makes sense
that applying the properties of equality will give another true statement. But we must be cognizant of that big
“IF”.
What if there was no value of 𝑥𝑥 to make the equation true? What is the effect of adding a number to both sides
MP.1 of the equation or multiplying both sides by a non-zero number?
There still will be no value of 𝑥𝑥 that makes the equation true. The solution set is still preserved; it will
be the empty set.
Create another equation that initially seems like a reasonable equation to solve but in fact has no possible
solution.
Exercise 2 (7 minutes)
Exercise 2
a. Verify that this has the solution set {−𝟑𝟑, 𝟐𝟐}. Draw this solution set as a graph on the number line. We will later
learn how to show that these happen to be the ONLY solutions to this equation.
b. Let’s add four to both sides of the equation and consider the new equation 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝒙𝒙. Verify 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟑𝟑 are
still solutions.
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟐𝟐 True. (−𝟑𝟑)𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − (−𝟑𝟑) True. They are still solutions.
c. Let’s now add 𝒙𝒙 to both sides of the equation and consider the new equation 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓 + 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. Are 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟑𝟑 still
solutions?
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓 + 𝟐𝟐 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 True. (−𝟑𝟑)𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓 + −𝟑𝟑 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 True. 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟑𝟑 are still solutions.
d. Let’s add −𝟓𝟓 to both sides of the equation and consider the new equation 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟔𝟔. Are 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟑𝟑 still solutions?
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟐𝟐 = 𝟔𝟔 True. (−𝟑𝟑)𝟐𝟐 + −𝟑𝟑 = 𝟔𝟔 True. 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟑𝟑 are still solutions.
𝟏𝟏 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 +𝒙𝒙
e. Let’s multiply both sides by to get = 𝟏𝟏. Are 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟑𝟑 still solutions?
𝟔𝟔 𝟔𝟔
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 +𝟐𝟐 (−𝟑𝟑)𝟐𝟐 +(−𝟑𝟑)
= 𝟏𝟏 True. = 𝟏𝟏 True. 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟑𝟑 are still solutions.
𝟔𝟔 𝟔𝟔
f. Let’s go back to part (d) and add 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 to both sides of the equation and consider the new equation
𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 = 𝟔𝟔 + 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑. Are 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟑𝟑 still solutions?
Discussion (4 minutes)
In addition to applying the commutative, associative, and distributive properties to equations, according to the
exercises above, what else can be done to equations that does not change the solution set?
Adding a number to or subtracting a number from both sides.
Multiplying or dividing by a non-zero number.
What we discussed in Example 1 can be rewritten slightly to reflect what we have just seen: If 𝑥𝑥 is a solution to
an equation, it will also be a solution to the new equation formed when the same number is added to (or
subtracted from) each side of the original equation or when the two sides of the original equation are
multiplied by the same number or divided by the same non-zero number. These are referred to as the
Properties of Equality. This now gives us a strategy for finding solution sets.
Is 𝑥𝑥 = 5 an equation? If, so what is its solution set?
Yes, its solution set is 5.
This example is so simple that it is hard to wrap your brain around, but it points out that if ever we have an
equation that is this simple, we know its solution set.
We also know the solution sets to some other simple equations, such as
(a) 𝑤𝑤 2 = 64 (b) 7 + 𝑃𝑃 = 5 (c) 3𝛽𝛽 = 10
to keep rewriting the equation into one whose solution set you easily recognize. (We observed that the
solution set will not change under these operations.)
This usually means rewriting the equation so that all the terms with the variable appear on one side of the
equation.
Exercise 3 (5 minutes)
Exercise 3
𝟑𝟑 𝟏𝟏
a. Solve for 𝒓𝒓: = b. Solve for 𝒔𝒔: 𝒔𝒔𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 c. Solve for 𝒚𝒚: 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝟑𝟑 = 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟖𝟖
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 𝟒𝟒
𝒓𝒓 = 𝟔𝟔 𝒔𝒔 = 𝟓𝟓, 𝒔𝒔 = −𝟓𝟓 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟓𝟓
Exercise 4 (5 minutes)
Does it matter which step happens first? Let's see what happens with the following example.
Do a quick count-off or separate the class into quadrants. Give groups their starting points. Have each group designate
a presenter, so the whole class can see the results.
Exercise 4
Consider the equation 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟒𝟒 = 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. Solve for 𝒙𝒙 using the given starting point.
Therefore, according to this exercise, does it matter which step happens first? Explain why or why not.
No, because the properties of equality produce equivalent expressions, no matter the order in which
they happen.
How does one know “how much” to add/subtract/multiply/divide? What's the goal of using the properties and
how do they allow equations to be solved?
Encourage students to verbalize their strategies to the class and to question each other’s reasoning and question the
precision of each other’s description of their reasoning. From middle school, students recall that the goal is to isolate
the variable by making 0s and 1s. Add/subtract numbers to make the zeros, and multiply/divide numbers to make the
1s. The properties say any numbers will work, which is true, but with the 0s and 1s goal in mind, equations can be
solved very efficiently.
The ability to pick the most efficient solution method comes with practice.
Closing Exercise
a. Use the commutative property to create an equation with the same solution set.
MP.2
b. Using the result from (a), use the associative property to create an equation with the same solution set.
c. Using the result from (b), use the distributive property to create an equation with the same solution set.
d. Using the result from (c), add a number to both sides of the equation.
e. Using the result from (d), subtract a number from both sides of the equation.
f. Using the result from (e), multiply both sides of the equation by a number.
MP.2
𝟒𝟒(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟐𝟐) = 𝟒𝟒(𝒙𝒙𝟑𝟑 + 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝟐𝟐)
g. Using the result from (f), divide both sides of the equation by a number.
Lesson Summary
If 𝒙𝒙 is a solution to an equation, it will also be a solution to the new equation formed when the same number is
added to (or subtracted from) each side of the original equation or when the two sides of the original equation are
multiplied by (or divided by) the same non-zero number. These are referred to as the Properties of Equality.
If one is faced with the task of solving an equation, that is, finding the solution set of the equation:
Use the commutative, associative, and distributive properties, AND use the properties of equality (adding,
subtracting, multiplying by non-zeros, dividing by non-zeros) to keep rewriting the equation into one whose
solution set you easily recognize. (We believe that the solution set will not change under these operations.)
Exit Ticket
Determine which of the following equations have the same solution set by recognizing properties, rather than solving.
13
a. 2𝑥𝑥 + 3 = 13 − 5𝑥𝑥 b. 6 + 4𝑥𝑥 = −10𝑥𝑥 + 26 c. 6𝑥𝑥 + 9 = − 𝑥𝑥
5
13
d. 0.6 + 0.4𝑥𝑥 = −𝑥𝑥 + 2.6 e. 3(2𝑥𝑥 + 3) = − 𝑥𝑥 f. 4𝑥𝑥 = −10𝑥𝑥 + 20
5
Determine which of the following equations have the same solution set by recognizing properties, rather than solving.
a. b.
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙 𝟔𝟔 + 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 = −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 c. 𝟔𝟔𝒙𝒙 + 𝟗𝟗 = − 𝒙𝒙
𝟓𝟓
d.
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 f.
𝟎𝟎. 𝟔𝟔 + 𝟎𝟎. 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 = −𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐. 𝟔𝟔 e. 𝟑𝟑(𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑) = − 𝒙𝒙 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 = −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝟓𝟓
(a), (b), (d), and (f) have the same solution set. (c), (e), (g), and (h) have the same solution set.
1. Which of the following equations have the same solution set? Give reasons for your answers that do not depend on
solving the equations.
𝒙𝒙 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
IV. 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 V. 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 VI. −𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 + = + 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
I, V, and VI all have the same solution set; V is the same as I after multiplying both sides by 𝟑𝟑 and switching the left
side with the right side; VI is the same as 𝟏𝟏 after dividing both sides by 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and using the commutative property to
rearrange the terms on the left side of the equation.
II and IV have the same solution set. IV is the same as II after multiplying both sides by 𝟐𝟐 and subtracting 𝟒𝟒 from
both sides.
III does not have the same solution set as any of the others.
Solve the following equations, check your solutions, and then graph the solution sets.
5. 𝟕𝟕 − 𝟖𝟖𝒙𝒙 = 𝟕𝟕( 𝟏𝟏 + 𝟕𝟕𝒙𝒙) 6. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 − 𝟖𝟖𝒏𝒏 = −𝟖𝟖(𝟑𝟑 + 𝟒𝟒𝒏𝒏) + 𝟑𝟑𝒏𝒏 7. (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓) = 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐
{𝟎𝟎} {−𝟑𝟑} no solution
8. 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟕𝟕 = 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟔𝟔𝒙𝒙 − 𝟕𝟕 9. −𝟕𝟕 − 𝟔𝟔𝒂𝒂 + 𝟓𝟓𝒂𝒂 = 𝟑𝟑𝒂𝒂 − 𝟓𝟓𝒂𝒂 10. 𝟕𝟕 − 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏 − 𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙
{𝟎𝟎} {𝟕𝟕} {−𝟔𝟔}
11. 𝟒𝟒(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐) = 𝟖𝟖(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑) − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 12. −𝟑𝟑(𝟏𝟏 − 𝒏𝒏) = −𝟔𝟔 − 𝟔𝟔𝒏𝒏 13. −𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟖𝟖𝒂𝒂 = −𝟓𝟓(𝒂𝒂 + 𝟔𝟔)
{𝟕𝟕} 𝟏𝟏 {𝟑𝟑}
�− �
𝟑𝟑
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙
14. −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟐𝟐𝒑𝒑 = 𝟔𝟔𝒑𝒑 + 𝟓𝟓(𝒑𝒑 + 𝟑𝟑) 15. = 𝟒𝟒 16. 𝟐𝟐 + = − 𝟑𝟑
𝒙𝒙+𝟐𝟐 𝟗𝟗 𝟑𝟑
{−𝟐𝟐} 𝟖𝟖 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
�− � � �
𝟑𝟑 𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙+𝟒𝟒 𝒙𝒙+𝟐𝟐
17. −𝟓𝟓(−𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙 − 𝟔𝟔) = −𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝒙𝒙 18. = 19. −𝟓𝟓(𝟐𝟐𝒓𝒓 − 𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑) + 𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓(𝟒𝟒𝒓𝒓 + 𝟑𝟑) = −𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔
𝟑𝟑 𝟓𝟓
{−𝟐𝟐} 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔
{−𝟕𝟕} � �
𝟖𝟖
Student Outcomes
Students learn “if-then” moves using the properties of equality to solve equations. Students also explore
moves that may result in an equation having more solutions than the original equation.
In previous lessons we have looked at techniques for solving equations, a common theme throughout algebra. In this
lesson, we will examine some potential dangers where our intuition about algebra may need to be examined.
Exercise 1 (4 minutes)
Give students a few minutes to answer the questions individually. Then, elicit responses from students.
Exercise 1
a. Describe the property used to convert the equation from one line to the next:
𝒙𝒙(𝟏𝟏 − 𝒙𝒙) + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟒𝟒 = 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙 − 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 − 𝟒𝟒 = 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 distributive property
𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟒𝟒 = 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 added 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 to both sides of the equation
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 − 𝟒𝟒 = 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 collected like terms
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 added 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 to both sides of the equation
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 subtracted 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 from both sides of the equation
In each of the steps above, we applied a property of real numbers and/or equations to create a new
equation.
b. Why are we sure that the initial equation 𝒙𝒙(𝟏𝟏 − 𝒙𝒙) + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟒𝟒 = 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 and the final equation
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 have the same solution set?
We established last class that making use of the commutative, associative, and distributive properties, and
properties of equality to “rewrite” an equation does not change the solution set of the equation.
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟒𝟒
Do we know for certain that 𝑥𝑥 = 4 is the solution to every equation shown? Explain why.
Have students verify this by testing the solution in a couple of the equations.
Exercise 3 (8 minutes)
Exercise 3
Solve each equation for 𝒙𝒙. For each step, describe the operation used to convert the equation.
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
c. (𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓) = (𝟔𝟔 − 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒)
𝟐𝟐 𝟑𝟑
{𝟔𝟔}
Note with the class that students may have different approaches that arrived at the same answer.
Ask students how they handled the fraction in part (c).
Was it easier to use the distributive property first or multiply both sides by 6 first?
Lulu says, “Well, we’ve only said that for the properties of equality – adding quantities and multiplying by non-
zero quantities. (And associative, commutative, and distributive properties too.) Who knows if it is true in
general?”
If I follow the idea, “Whatever you do to the left, do to the right as well,” then I am in trouble. What if I decide
to remove the denominator on the left and also remove the denominator on the right. I get 𝑥𝑥 = 1. Is that a
solution?”
Fergus replies, “Well, that is silly. We all know that is a wrong thing to do. You should multiply both sides of
MP.3 that equation by 12. That gives 𝑥𝑥 = 4, and that does give the correct solution.”
Lulu says, “Okay Fergus, you have just acknowledged that there are some things we can’t do! Even if you don’t
like Mike’s example, he’s got a point.”
Mike or another student says, “What if I take your equation and choose to square each side. This gives
𝑥𝑥 2 1
=
144 9
144
Multiplying through by 144 gives 𝑥𝑥 2 = = 16, which has solutions 𝑥𝑥 = 4 AND 𝑥𝑥 = −4.”
9
Fergus responds, “Hmmm. Okay I do see the solution 𝑥𝑥 = 4, but the appearance of 𝑥𝑥 = −4 as well is weird.”
Mike says, “Lulu is right. Over the past two days we have learned that using the commutative, associative, and
distributive properties, along with the properties of equality (adding and multiplying equations throughout)
definitely DOES NOT change solution sets. BUT if we do anything different from this we might be in trouble.”
Lulu continues, “Yeah! Basically when we start doing unusual operations on an equation, we are really saying
that **IF** we have a solution to an equation, then it should be a solution to the next equation as well. BUT
remember, it could be that there was no solution to the first equation anyway!”
MP.3
Mike says, “So feel free to start doing weird things to both sides of an equation if you want (though you might
want to do sensible weird things!), but all you will be getting are possible CANDIDATES for solutions. You are
going to have to check at the end if they really are solutions.”
Exercise 4
𝟑𝟑 + 𝟏𝟏 = 𝟒𝟒
(𝟑𝟑 + 𝟏𝟏)𝟐𝟐 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 = −𝟓𝟓
c. Based on your results, what effect does squaring both sides of an equation appear to have on the solution set?
Answers will vary. The new equation seems to retain the original solution and add a second solution.
Exercise 5
a. Did squaring both sides of the equation affect the solution sets?
b. Based on your results, does your answer to part (c) of the previous question need to be modified?
The new equation retains the original solution and may add a second solution.
Exercise 6
a. Verify that 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏, 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟏𝟏, and 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐 are each solutions to this equation.
MP.3 (𝟏𝟏)𝟑𝟑 + 𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐(𝟏𝟏)𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏 True
b. Bonzo decides to apply the action “Ignore the exponents” on each side of the equation. He gets 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝒙𝒙. In
solving this equation, what does he obtain? What seems to be the problem with his technique?
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏; The problem is that he only finds one of the three solutions to the equation.
MP.3
c. What would Bonzo obtain if he applied his “method” to the equation 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝟐𝟐 = 𝒙𝒙𝟒𝟒 ? Is it a solution to the
original equation?
𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 = − ; No, it is not a solution to the original equation.
𝟐𝟐
Exercise 7
a. Multiply both sides of the equation by a constant, and show that the solution set did not change.
f. Based on your results, what effect does multiplying both sides of an equation by a constant have on the solution set
of the new equation?
g. Based on your results, what effect does multiplying both sides of an equation by a variable factor have on the
solution set of the new equation?
Multiplying by a variable factor could produce additional solution(s) to the solution set.
Closing (2 minutes)
What moves have we seen that do not change the solution set of an equation?
What moves did change the solution set?
What limitations are there to the principle “whatever you do to one side of the equation, you must do to the
other side?”
Lesson Summary
Assuming that there is a solution to an equation, applying the distributive, commutative, and associative properties
and the properties of equality to equations will not change the solution set.
Feel free to try doing other operations to both sides of an equation, but be aware that the new solution set you get
contains possible candidates for solutions. You have to plug each one into the original equation to see if it really is
a solution to your original equation.
Exit Ticket
1. Solve the equation for 𝑥𝑥. For each step, describe the operation and/or properties used to convert the equation.
5(2𝑥𝑥 − 4) − 11 = 4 + 3𝑥𝑥
a. Show that adding 𝑥𝑥 + 2 to both sides of the equation does not change the solution set.
b. Show that multiplying both sides of the equation by 𝑥𝑥 + 2 adds a second solution of 𝑥𝑥 = −2 to the solution
set.
1. Solve the equation for 𝒙𝒙. For each step, describe the operation and/or properties used to convert the equation.
b. Show that multiplying both sides of the equation by 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐 adds a second solution of 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟐𝟐 to the solution
set.
1. Solve each equation for 𝒙𝒙. For each step, describe the operation used to convert the equation. How do you know
that the initial equation and the final equation have the same solution set?
Students should write the new equations and the solution sets:
b. Multiply both sides by 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏 and find the solution set of the new equation.
c. Multiply both sides of the original equation by 𝒙𝒙 and find the solution set of the new equation.
3. Solve the equation 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 for 𝒙𝒙. Square both sides of the equation and verify that your solution satisfies this
𝟏𝟏
new equation. Show that − satisfies the new equation but not the original equation.
𝟑𝟑
The solution of 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 is 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏. The equation obtained by squaring is (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏)𝟐𝟐 = 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 .
Let 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏 in the new equation. (𝟏𝟏 + 𝟏𝟏)𝟐𝟐 = 𝟒𝟒(𝟏𝟏)𝟐𝟐 is true, so 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏 is still as solution.
𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
Let 𝒙𝒙 = − in the new equation. �− + 𝟏𝟏� = 𝟒𝟒 �− � is true, so x = − is also a solution to the new equation.
𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑
Yes.
Yes.
Yes.
Yes.
Student Outcomes
Students learn if-then moves using the addition and multiplication properties of inequality to solve inequalities
and graph the solution sets on the number line.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (5 minutes)
Allow students time to work through the warm up individually. Then, discuss results. Let several students share values
that work. For each part of the exercise, demonstrate that these values still work for each new inequality.
Exercise 1
a. Sift through some possible values to assign to 𝒙𝒙 that make this inequality a true statement. Find at least two
positive values that work and at least two negative values that work.
b. Should your four values also be solutions to the inequality 𝒙𝒙(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟒𝟒) ≥ 𝟓𝟓? Explain why or why not. Are they?
Yes, the inequality can be returned to its original form by using the distributive property, so the two are
equivalent.
c. Should your four values also be solutions to the inequality 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 ≥ 𝟓𝟓? Explain why or why not. Are they?
Yes, the terms on the left-hand side can be rearranged using the commutative property.
d. Should your four values also be solutions to the inequality 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟔𝟔 ≥ −𝟏𝟏? Explain why or why not. Are
they?
Yes, 𝟔𝟔 was subtracted from both sides of the inequality. If the same principle of equality holds for
inequalities, then the original solutions should still work. (Make sure students confirm this with their answers
from (a).
e. Should your four values also be solutions to the inequality 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 ≥ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏? Explain why or why not. Are
they?
Yes, both sides were multiplied by 𝟑𝟑. Using the same multiplication principle of Scaffold:
equality, the solution set should not change. (Again, make sure students test this.)
Remind students about the
significance of the open
circle or solid circle on the
endpoint of the solution
set.
While discussing parts (b) and (c), guide the class discussion to lead to the following conclusion:
Just like all our previous work on equations, rewriting an inequality via the commutative, associative, and
distributive properties of the real numbers does not change the solution set of that inequality.
Make the point that we’re talking about >, <, ≥, and ≤.
While discussing (d), point out that it appears we are choosing to accept the addition (and subtraction) property of
inequality (If 𝐴𝐴 > 𝐵𝐵, then 𝐴𝐴 + 𝑐𝑐 > 𝐵𝐵 + 𝑐𝑐). Students have previously referred to this property as an “if-then” move.
Ask students to articulate the property as formally as they can; for example, “adding a value to each side of an inequality
does not change the solution set of that inequality.”
Conduct a similar discussion to those conducted in Lesson 12. Include the following:
Could the solution set to an inequality be changed by applying the commutative, associative, or distributive
properties to either side of an inequality?
No, the solution set would not change.
Could the solution set to an inequality be changed by applying the additive property of inequality?
No, the solution set would not change.
While discussing (e), make the same argument for multiplying both sides of an inequality by a positive value:
If 𝐴𝐴 > 𝐵𝐵, then 𝑘𝑘𝑘𝑘 > 𝑘𝑘𝑘𝑘 provided 𝑘𝑘 is positive.
This action also does not change the solution set of an inequality.
So if 𝑥𝑥 is a solution to an inequality, it will also be a solution to the new inequality formed when the same
number is added to or subtracted from each side of the original inequality or when the two sides of the
original inequality are multiplied by the same positive number. This gives us a strategy for finding solution
sets.
Example 1 (2 minutes)
Work through the example as a class using the addition and multiplication properties of inequality.
Example 1
What is the solution set to the inequality 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 > 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐? Express the solution set in words, in set notation, and
graphically on the number line.
𝒒𝒒 > 𝟐𝟐
Point out to students that these are the only actions that we know do not affect the solution set.
1
Dividing both sides by 5 is still applying the multiplication principle (multiplying both sides by ).
5
Exercise 2 (6 minutes)
Allow students time to complete the problems individually and then pair up to compare responses.
Exercise 2
Find the solution set to each inequality. Express the solution in set notation and graphically on the number line.
Exercise 3
Recall the discussion on all the strange ideas for what could be done to both sides of an equation. Let’s explore some of
the same issues here but with inequalities. Recall, in this lesson we have established that adding (or subtracting) and
multiplying through by positive quantities does not change the solution set of an inequality. We’ve made no comment
about other operations.
a. Squaring: Do 𝑩𝑩 ≤ 𝟔𝟔 and 𝑩𝑩𝟐𝟐 ≤ 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 have the same solution set? If not, give an example of a number that is in one
solution set but not the other.
No. In the first inequality, 𝑩𝑩 can equal 𝟔𝟔 or any number smaller. The second inequality can only equal numbers from
𝟔𝟔 down to −𝟔𝟔. For example, 𝑩𝑩 = −𝟕𝟕 is not in the solution set.
b. Multiplying through by a negative number: Do 𝟓𝟓 − 𝑪𝑪 > 𝟐𝟐 and −𝟓𝟓 + 𝑪𝑪 > −𝟐𝟐 have the same solution set? If not,
give an example of a number that is in one solution set but not the other.
No. The first inequality has a solution of 𝑪𝑪 < 𝟑𝟑, and the second has a solution of 𝑪𝑪 > 𝟑𝟑. The number 𝟒𝟒, for example,
is a solution to the second but not the first inequality.
c. Bonzo’s ignoring exponents: Do 𝒚𝒚𝟐𝟐 < 𝟓𝟓𝟐𝟐 and 𝒚𝒚 < 𝟓𝟓 have the same solution set?
No. When both sides are squared, we end up introducing the possibility that 𝒚𝒚 can be negative but not less than −𝟓𝟓.
For example, 𝒚𝒚 = −𝟓𝟓 is a solution for the second inequality but not the first.
Recall that we have established that making use of the properties of inequalities:
If 𝐴𝐴 > 𝐵𝐵, then 𝐴𝐴 + 𝑐𝑐 > 𝐵𝐵 + 𝑐𝑐 for any real number 𝑐𝑐.
If 𝐴𝐴 > 𝐵𝐵, then 𝑘𝑘𝑘𝑘 > 𝑘𝑘𝑘𝑘 for any positive real number k.
Along with all the usual commutative, associative, and distributive properties, to rewrite an inequality does not
change the solution set of that inequality.
Any action different from these offers no guarantee that your work is yielding valid solutions. These may be
candidates you can use to check for solutions, but they must be checked (as we saw in the previous exercise).
The next two examples illustrate some more dangers.
Example 2 (2 minutes)
Work through the responses as a class reminding students of dangers that were seen in Lesson 13.
Example 2
Jojo was asked to solve 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 < 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟔𝟔, for 𝒙𝒙. She answered as follows:
a. Since the final line is a false statement, she deduced that there is no solution to this inequality (that the solution set
is empty).
MP.3 What is the solution set to 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 < 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟔𝟔?
𝒙𝒙 < −𝟐𝟐
Example 3 (3 minutes)
During the last exercise, we saw that when both sides were multiplied by −1 the solution set of the inequality
changed.
So, we can’t multiply through by −1 as this does not match the allowable operations given by the properties of
inequality. However, we can use the property: If 𝐴𝐴 > 𝐵𝐵, then 𝐴𝐴 + 𝑐𝑐 > 𝐵𝐵 + 𝑐𝑐 for any real number 𝑐𝑐. Can you
MP.1 figure out how to use this property in a way that is helpful?
Allow students time to work the problem, individually or in pairs, and then discuss the solution.
Example 3
−𝒒𝒒 ≥ −𝟕𝟕
𝟎𝟎 ≥ −𝟕𝟕 + 𝒒𝒒 Add 𝒒𝒒 to both sides
Exercise 4
Find the solution set to each inequality. Express the solution in set notation and graphically on the number line.
Exercise 5
Use the properties of inequality to show that each of the following are true for any real numbers 𝒑𝒑 and 𝒒𝒒.
a. If 𝒑𝒑 ≥ 𝒒𝒒, then −𝒑𝒑 ≤ −𝒒𝒒. b. If 𝒑𝒑 < 𝒒𝒒, then −𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 > −𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓.
𝒑𝒑 ≥ 𝒒𝒒 𝒑𝒑 < 𝒒𝒒
MP.2 𝒑𝒑 − 𝒒𝒒 ≥ 𝒒𝒒 − 𝒒𝒒 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 < 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
𝒑𝒑 − 𝒒𝒒 ≥ 𝟎𝟎 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 < 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
𝒑𝒑 − 𝒑𝒑 − 𝒒𝒒 ≥ 𝟎𝟎 − 𝒑𝒑 −𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 < −𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
−𝒒𝒒 ≥ −𝒑𝒑 −𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 > −𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
−𝒑𝒑 ≤ −𝒒𝒒
𝒑𝒑 ≤ 𝒒𝒒
𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 ≤ 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎
MP.2
𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 ≤ 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎
−𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 ≤ −𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎
−𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 ≥ −𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎
d. Based on the results from (a) through (c), how might we expand the multiplication property of inequality?
If 𝑨𝑨 > 𝑩𝑩, then 𝒌𝒌𝒌𝒌 < 𝒌𝒌𝒌𝒌 for any negative real number 𝒌𝒌.
Exercise 6
Solve −𝟒𝟒 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 > −𝟔𝟔 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, for 𝒕𝒕 in two different ways: first without ever multiplying through by a
𝟏𝟏
negative number and then by first multiplying through by − .
𝟐𝟐
Exercise 7
𝒙𝒙 𝟏𝟏
Solve − + 𝟖𝟖 < , for 𝒙𝒙 in two different ways: first without ever multiplying through by a negative number and then by
𝟒𝟒 𝟐𝟐
first multiplying through by −𝟒𝟒.
𝒙𝒙 𝟏𝟏
− + 𝟖𝟖 < 𝒙𝒙 𝟏𝟏
𝟒𝟒 𝟐𝟐 −𝟒𝟒(− + 𝟖𝟖) > −𝟒𝟒 � �
𝟒𝟒 𝟐𝟐
𝟏𝟏 𝒙𝒙
𝟖𝟖 − < 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 > −𝟐𝟐
𝟐𝟐 𝟒𝟒
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝟒𝟒 ∙ < 𝟒𝟒 ∙
𝟐𝟐 𝟒𝟒
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 < 𝒙𝒙
Closing (2 minutes)
What moves do we know do not change the solution set of an inequality?
What moves did we see today that did change the solution set?
Exit Ticket
1. Find the solution set to each inequality. Express the solution in set notation and graphically on the number line.
a. 6𝑥𝑥 − 5 < 7𝑥𝑥 + 4 b. 𝑥𝑥 2 + 3(𝑥𝑥 − 1) ≥ 𝑥𝑥 2 + 5
2. Fergus was absent for today’s lesson and asked Mike to explain why the solution to −5𝑥𝑥 > 30 is 𝑥𝑥 < −6. Mike said,
“Oh! That’s easy. When you multiply by a negative, just flip the inequality.” Provide a better explanation to Fergus
about why the direction of the inequality is reversed.
1. Find the solution set to each inequality. Express the solution in set notation and graphically on the number line.
a. 𝟔𝟔𝒙𝒙 – 𝟓𝟓 < 𝟕𝟕𝒙𝒙 + 𝟒𝟒 b. 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟑𝟑(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏) ≥ 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓
2. Fergus was absent for today’s lesson and asked Mike to explain why the solution to −𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 > 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 is 𝒙𝒙 < −𝟔𝟔. Mike
said, “Oh! That’s easy. When you multiply by a negative, just flip the inequality.” Provide a better explanation to
Fergus about why the direction of the inequality is reversed.
The multiplication property of inequality only applies when multiplying by a positive value. Otherwise, the addition
property must be used.
1. Find the solution set to each inequality. Express the solution in set notation and graphically on the number line.
a. 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 < 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
b. −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒙𝒙 ≥ −𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
𝟐𝟐 𝟏𝟏
c. 𝒙𝒙 ≠ + 𝟐𝟐
𝟑𝟑 𝟐𝟐
𝟐𝟐
2. Find the mistake in the following set of steps in a student’s attempt to solve 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 + 𝟐𝟐 ≥ 𝒙𝒙 + , for 𝒙𝒙. What is the
𝟓𝟓
correct solution set?
𝟐𝟐
𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐 ≥ 𝒙𝒙 +
𝟓𝟓
𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
𝟓𝟓 �𝒙𝒙 + � ≥ 𝒙𝒙 + (factoring out 𝟓𝟓 on the left side)
𝟓𝟓 𝟓𝟓
𝟐𝟐
𝟓𝟓 ≥ 𝟏𝟏 (dividing by �𝒙𝒙 + �)
𝟓𝟓
So, the solution set is the empty set.
𝟐𝟐
The third line of the solution is incorrect. Since 𝒙𝒙 is a variable, we do not know whether 𝒙𝒙 + is positive, negative,
𝟓𝟓
𝟐𝟐
or zero. The correct solution to the given problem is 𝒙𝒙 ≥ − .
𝟓𝟓
𝒙𝒙 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
3. Solve − + 𝟏𝟏 ≥ − , for 𝒙𝒙 without multiplying by a negative number. Then solve by multiplying through by −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 𝒙𝒙 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
− + 𝟏𝟏 ≥ − −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏(− + 𝟏𝟏) ≤ −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 �− �
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐
𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 ≤ 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
− ≥ −𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
−𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 ≤ 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
≥ −𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 − ≤ 𝒙𝒙
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 ≥ −
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
4. Lisa brought half of her savings to the bakery and bought 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 croissants for $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. The amount of money she
brings home with her is more than $𝟐𝟐. Use an inequality to find how much money she had in her savings before
going to the bakery. (Write the inequalities that represents the situation and solve it.)
𝒙𝒙
The inequality is 𝟐𝟐 < − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. 𝟐𝟐. The original savings amount must have been more than $𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑. 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒.
𝟐𝟐
Student Outcomes
Students describe the solution set of two equations (or inequalities) joined by either “and” or “or” and graph
the solution set on the number line.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (6 minutes)
It may be helpful to some students to review some of the vocabulary used here, such as compound sentence (a sentence
that contains at least two clauses) or declarative sentence (a sentence in the form of a statement).
Give students a few minutes to work on the exploration independently and then 1 minute to compare answers with a
partner. Discuss results as a class, particularly the difference between separating the declarations by “and” and by “or.”
Exercise 1
a. Right now, I am in math class and English class. b. Right now, I am in math class or English class.
True False
True False
g. When the two declarations in the sentences above were separated by “and,” what had to be true to make the
statement true?
h. When the two declarations in the sentences above were separated by “or,” what had to be true to make the
statement true?
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 177
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 15 M1
ALGEBRA I
Example 1 (5 minutes)
Work through the four examples as a class.
Example 1
a. 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟖𝟖 = 𝟑𝟑 or 𝒙𝒙 – 𝟔𝟔 = 𝟐𝟐 b. 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝟗𝟗 = 𝟎𝟎 or 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙 = −𝟓𝟓 or 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟖𝟖 𝟗𝟗
𝒙𝒙 = or 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟏𝟏
𝟒𝟒
{−𝟓𝟓, 𝟖𝟖}
𝟗𝟗
�−𝟏𝟏, �
𝟒𝟒
{𝟕𝟕} ∅
Exercise 2
a. Using a colored pencil, graph the inequality 𝐱𝐱 < 𝟑𝟑 on the number line below.
b. Using a different colored pencil, graph the inequality 𝒙𝒙 > −𝟏𝟏 on the number line below.
c. Using a third colored pencil, darken the section of the number line where 𝒙𝒙 < 𝟑𝟑 and 𝒙𝒙 > −𝟏𝟏.
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 178
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 15 M1
ALGEBRA I
In order for the compound sentence 𝑥𝑥 > −1 and 𝑥𝑥 < 3 to be true, what has to be true about 𝑥𝑥?
𝑥𝑥 has to be both greater than −1 and less than 3. (Students might also verbalize that it must be
between −1 and 3, not including the points −1 and 3.)
On the graph, where do the solutions lie?
Between −1 and 3, not including the points −1 and 3
Have students list some of the solutions to the compound inequality. Make sure to include examples of integer and non-
integer solutions.
How many solutions are there to this compound inequality?
An infinite number
Introduce the abbreviated way of writing this sentence:
Sometimes this is written as −1 < 𝑥𝑥 < 3.
Use this notation to further illustrate the idea of 𝑥𝑥 representing all numbers strictly between −1 and 3.
Allow students a couple of minutes to complete (d) through (f). Then, stop and discuss the results.
d. Using a colored pencil, graph the inequality 𝒙𝒙 < −𝟒𝟒 on the number line below.
e. Using a different colored pencil, graph the inequality 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟎𝟎 on the number line below.
f. Using a third colored pencil, darken the section of the number line where 𝒙𝒙 < −𝟒𝟒 or 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟎𝟎.
In order for the compound sentence 𝑥𝑥 < −4 or 𝑥𝑥 > 0 to be true, what has to be true about 𝑥𝑥?
It could either be less than −4, or it could be greater than 0.
On the graph, where do the solutions lie?
To the left of −4 and to the right of 0
Have students list solutions to the compound inequality. Make sure to include examples of integer and non-integer
solutions.
How many solutions are there to this compound inequality?
Infinitely many
Would it be acceptable to abbreviate this compound sentence as follows: 0 < 𝑥𝑥 < −4?
No.
Explain why not.
Those symbols suggest that 𝑥𝑥 must be greater than zero and less than −4 at the same time, but the
solution is calling for 𝑥𝑥 to be either less than −4 or greater than zero.
Allow students a couple of minutes to complete (g) through (i) and discuss answers.
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 179
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 15 M1
ALGEBRA I
g. Graph the compound sentence 𝒙𝒙 > −𝟐𝟐 or 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟐𝟐 on the number line below.
𝒙𝒙 ≥ −𝟐𝟐
i. Rewrite 𝒙𝒙 ≤ 𝟒𝟒 as a compound sentence and graph the solutions to the sentence on the number line below.
𝒙𝒙 < 𝟒𝟒 or 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟒𝟒
Example 2 (3 minutes)
Work through Example 2 as a class.
Example 2
a. 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐 or 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟔𝟔
b. 𝒙𝒙 ≤ −𝟓𝟓 or 𝒙𝒙 ≥ 𝟐𝟐
c. 𝟏𝟏 ≤ 𝒙𝒙 ≤ 𝟑𝟑
𝒙𝒙 ≥ 𝟏𝟏 and 𝒙𝒙 ≤ 𝟑𝟑
Exercise 3 (5 minutes)
Give students a couple of minutes to read through Exercise 3 and try it independently before comparing answers with a
neighbor or discussing as a class.
Exercise 3
Consider the following two scenarios. For each, specify the variable and say, “𝑾𝑾 is the width of the rectangle,” for
example, and write a compound inequality that represents the scenario given. Draw its solution set on a number line.
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 180
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 15 M1
ALGEBRA I
Exercise 4
True True
g. h.
g.
i. A poll shows that a candidate is projected to receive 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓% of the votes. If the margin for error is plus or minus 𝟑𝟑%,
write a compound inequality for the percentage of votes the candidate can expect to get.
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 181
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 15 M1
ALGEBRA I
j. Mercury is one of only two elements that is liquid at room temperature. Mercury is non-liquid for temperatures less
than −𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑. 𝟎𝟎°F or greater than 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔. 𝟖𝟖°F. Write a compound inequality for the temperatures at which mercury is
non-liquid.
Let 𝒙𝒙 = temperatures (in degrees F) for which mercury is non-liquid 𝒙𝒙 < −𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 or 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔. 𝟖𝟖
As an extension, students can come up with ways to alter parts (a) and (b) to make them false compound statements.
Share several responses.
Ask the following:
What would be a more concise way of writing the sentence for part (e)? Scaffolding:
𝑥𝑥 ≠ 8 The other element that is
For part (f), list some numbers that are solutions to the inequality. liquid at room
What is the largest possible value of 𝑥𝑥? temperature is bromine.
Students could be asked to
10
look up the temperatures
MP.2 What is the smallest possible value of 𝑥𝑥? at which bromine is non-
This is tougher to answer. 𝑥𝑥 can be infinitely close to 0 but cannot equal liquid and write a similar
zero. Therefore, there is no absolute smallest value for 𝑥𝑥 in this case. compound inequality.
For parts (i) and (j), make sure students specify what the variable they choose represents.
Closing (2 minutes)
Lead a conversation on the idea that in math, as in English, it is important that we are precise in our use of language and
that we are able to read (and comprehend) and write mathematical sentences. Ask students to give examples to justify
why the precision is important in math, and why it is important in English.
MP.6
Reinforce that, in mathematical sentences, like in English sentences, a compound sentence separated by
AND is true if both clauses are true.
OR is true if at least one of the clauses is true.
Lesson Summary
In mathematical sentences, like in English sentences, a compound sentence separated by
OR is true if __________________________________________________________________.
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 182
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 15 M1
ALGEBRA I
Exit Ticket
1.
a. Solve the system and graph the solution set on a number line.
𝑥𝑥 − 15 = 5 or 2𝑥𝑥 + 5 = 1
b. Write a different system of equations that would have the same solution set.
2. Swimming pools must have a certain amount of chlorine content. The United States standard for safe levels of
chlorine in swimming pools is at least 1 part per million and no greater than 3 parts per million. Write a compound
inequality for the acceptable range of chlorine levels.
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 183
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 15 M1
ALGEBRA I
1.
a. Solve the system and graph the solution set on a number line.
𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟓𝟓 or 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟏𝟏
b. Write a different system of equations that would have the same solution set.
2. Swimming pools must have a certain amount of chlorine content. The United States standard for safe levels of
chlorine in swimming pools is at least 𝟏𝟏 part per million and no greater than 𝟑𝟑 parts per million. Write a compound
inequality for the acceptable range of chlorine levels.
For the first sentence, both statements must be true, so x can only equal values that are both greater than −𝟏𝟏 and
less than 𝟏𝟏. For the second sentence, only one statement must be true, so 𝒙𝒙 must be greater than −𝟏𝟏 or less than 𝟏𝟏.
This means 𝒙𝒙 can equal any number on the number line.
There are an infinite number of solutions. 𝒙𝒙 can be any value between 𝟎𝟎 and 𝟑𝟑, which includes the integer
values of 𝟏𝟏 and 𝟐𝟐 as well as non-integer values. The set of numbers between 𝟎𝟎 and 𝟑𝟑 is infinite.
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 184
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 15 M1
ALGEBRA I
d. What are the largest and smallest possible values for 𝒙𝒙? Explain.
There is no absolute largest or absolute smallest value for 𝒙𝒙. 𝒙𝒙 can be infinitely close to 𝟎𝟎 or to 𝟑𝟑 but cannot
equal either value.
e. If the inequality is changed to 𝟎𝟎 ≤ 𝒙𝒙 ≤ 𝟑𝟑, then what are the largest and smallest possible values for 𝒙𝒙?
In this case, we can define the absolute maximum value to be 𝟑𝟑 and the absolute minimum value to be 𝟎𝟎.
6. Unsafe body temperatures are those lower than 96°F or above 104°F.
𝒙𝒙 = body temperature (in degrees F) that are unsafe 𝒙𝒙 < 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 or 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
8. 𝒙𝒙 < 𝟓𝟓 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟎𝟎
9. 𝒙𝒙 ≤ −𝟖𝟖 or 𝒙𝒙 ≥ −𝟏𝟏
12. 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓 < 𝟕𝟕 or 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐
Lesson 15: Solution Sets of Two or More Equations (or Inequalities) Joined by “And”
or “Or” 185
Date: 5/28/14
This work is licensed under a
© 2014 Common Core, Inc. Some rights reserved. commoncore.org
Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License.
NYS COMMON CORE MATHEMATICS CURRICULUM Lesson 16 M1
ALGEBRA I
Student Outcomes
Students solve two inequalities joined by “and” or “or” and then graph the solution set on the number line.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (5 minutes)
Do parts (a)–(c) and as much of (d)–(e) as time permits depending on the level of your students. You can also present
the challenge problem given below if time allows.
Exercise 1
a. Solve 𝒘𝒘𝟐𝟐 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, for 𝒘𝒘. Graph the solution on a number line.
b. Solve 𝒘𝒘𝟐𝟐 < 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, for 𝒘𝒘. Graph the solution on a number line and write the solution set as a compound inequality.
c. Solve 𝒘𝒘𝟐𝟐 ≥ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 for 𝒘𝒘. Graph the solution on a number line and write the solution set as a compound inequality.
𝒙𝒙 ≤ −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 or 𝒙𝒙 ≥ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
d. Quickly solve (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟕𝟕)𝟐𝟐 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, for 𝒙𝒙. Graph the solution on a number line.
e. Use your work from part (d) to quickly graph the solution on a number line to each inequality below.
i. (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟕𝟕)𝟐𝟐 < 𝟏𝟏𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
Extension
Scaffolding:
Use the following to challenge students who finish early. Remind students of their
a. 2 2
Poindexter says that (𝑎𝑎 + 𝑏𝑏) equals 𝑎𝑎 + 2𝑎𝑎𝑎𝑎 + 𝑏𝑏 . Is he correct? 2 experience from the
previous lesson. For a
b. Solve 𝑥𝑥 2 + 14𝑥𝑥 + 49 < 121, for 𝑥𝑥. Present the solution graphically on a
statement separated by
number line.
“and” to be true, BOTH
statements must be true.
If it is separated by “or,” at
Exercises 2–3 (6 minutes)
least one statement must
Give students 4 minutes to work on Exercises 2 and 3. Then, discuss the results as a class. be true.
Students are applying their knowledge from the previous lesson to solve an unfamiliar
type of problem.
Exercise 2
Exercise 3
b. Solve each inequality for 𝒙𝒙. Then, write the solution to the compound inequality.
𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑
𝒙𝒙 > −𝟑𝟑 and 𝒙𝒙 < OR −𝟑𝟑 < 𝒙𝒙 <
𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
Review Exercise 3 with students to demonstrate how to solve it without rewriting it.
A friend of mine suggested I could solve the inequality as follows. Is she right?
−5 < 2𝑥𝑥 + 1 < 4
−5 − 1 < 2𝑥𝑥 + 1 − 1 < 4 − 1
−6 < 2𝑥𝑥 < 3
3
−3 < 𝑥𝑥 <
2
MP.3
Encourage students to articulate their thoughts and scrutinize each other’s reasoning.
Point out to students that solving the two inequalities did not require any new skills. They are solved just as they
learned in previous lessons.
Have students verify their solution by filling in a few test values.
3
Remind students that the solution can be written two ways: 𝑥𝑥 > −3 and 𝑥𝑥 <
2
Scaffolding:
3
OR −3 < 𝑥𝑥 < . Remind students that
2
when an inequality is
multiplied or divided by a
Exercises 4–5 (5 minutes) negative number, the
direction of the inequality
Give students 4 minutes to work on Exercises 4 and 5. Then, review the results as a class.
changes.
Again, point out to students that solving the two inequalities did not require any new
skills. They are solved just as they learned in previous lessons. Have students verify their
solutions by filling in a few test values.
Exercise 4
a. What must be true in order for the compound inequality to be a true statement?
One of the statements must be true, so either 𝒙𝒙 has to be less than −𝟑𝟑, or it has to be greater than −𝟏𝟏. (In
this case it is not possible that both are true.)
𝒙𝒙 can be any number that is less than −𝟑𝟑 or any number that is greater than −𝟏𝟏.
Exercise 5
a. Solve each inequality for 𝒙𝒙. Then, write the solution to the compound inequality.
𝒙𝒙 < 𝟐𝟐 or 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟒𝟒
𝒙𝒙 can be any number that is less than 𝟐𝟐 or any number that is greater than 𝟒𝟒.
Exercise 6
Solve each compound inequality for 𝒙𝒙 and graph the solution on a number line.
c. 𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏 < 𝟎𝟎 or 𝟖𝟖 ≤ 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟓𝟓
𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 < − or 𝒙𝒙 ≥ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟓𝟓
𝒙𝒙 < 𝟒𝟒 or 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟒𝟒 𝒙𝒙 ≤ 𝟒𝟒
e. 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐 < 𝟒𝟒 or 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐 > 𝟒𝟒
𝒙𝒙 < 𝟔𝟔 or 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟔𝟔 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟔𝟔
f. 𝒙𝒙 – 𝟐𝟐 ≤ 𝟒𝟒 and 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐 ≥ 𝟒𝟒
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟔𝟔
Exercise 7 (9 minutes)
Have students work in groups to answer the questions. Students are exploring variations of previously seen problems.
After completing the exercises, ask students to articulate how the problems differed from most of the other examples
seen thus far.
Exercise 7
Solve each compound inequality for 𝒙𝒙 and graph the solution on a number line. Pay careful attention to the inequality
symbols and the “and” or “or” statements as you work.
No solution (empty set) since there are no numbers that satisfy both statements.
Closing (2 minutes)
For the first problem, students may have written the solution as 𝑥𝑥 > −5 or 𝑥𝑥 > −2. Look at the graph as a class and
remind them that the solution is the set of all of the numbers included in either of the two solution sets (or the union of
the two sets). Lead them to the idea that the solution is 𝑥𝑥 > −5.
For the second problem, the two graphs overlap and span the entire number line. Lead them to the idea that the
solution is all real numbers. Have students fill in a few test values to verify that any number will work.
For the third problem, the two graphs do not overlap. Remind them that the solution set is only the values that are in
both of the individual solution sets. There is no number that will make both statements true. Lead them to the idea that
there is no solution.
Read the questions at the end of the exploration and give students a few minutes to summarize their thoughts on the
work in Exercise 7 independently. Call for a few volunteers to read their solutions.
Exit Ticket
1. Solve each compound inequality for 𝑥𝑥 and graph the solution on a number line.
a. 9 + 2𝑥𝑥 < 17 or 7 − 4𝑥𝑥 < −9
𝑥𝑥
b. 6≤ ≤ 11
2
2.
a. Give an example of a compound inequality separated by “or” that has a solution of all real numbers.
b. Take the example from (a) and change the “or” to an “and.” Explain why the solution set is no longer all real
numbers. Use a graph on a number line as part of your explanation.
1. Solve each compound inequality for 𝒙𝒙 and graph the solution on a number line.
a. 𝟗𝟗 + 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 < 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 or 𝟕𝟕 − 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 < −𝟗𝟗
𝒙𝒙 < 𝟒𝟒 or 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟒𝟒 or 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟒𝟒
𝒙𝒙
b. 𝟔𝟔 ≤ ≤ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟐𝟐
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 ≤ 𝒙𝒙 ≤ 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
2.
a. Give an example of a compound inequality separated by “or” that has a solution of all real numbers.
b. Take the example from (a) and change the “or” to an “and.” Explain why the solution set is no longer all real
numbers. Use a graph on a number line as part of your explanation.
In the first example, only one of the inequalities needs to be true to make the compound statement true. Any
number selected is either greater than 𝟎𝟎 or less than 𝟐𝟐 or both. In the second example, both inequalities must
be true to make the compound statement true. This restricts the solution set to only numbers between 𝟎𝟎 and
𝟐𝟐.
Solve each inequality for 𝒙𝒙 and graph the solution on a number line.
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙+𝟏𝟏
1. 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐 < 𝟔𝟔 or > 𝟒𝟒 2. −𝟔𝟔 < < 𝟑𝟑
𝟑𝟑 𝟒𝟒
𝒙𝒙 < 𝟖𝟖 or 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 −𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 < 𝒙𝒙 < 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
3. 𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙 ≤ 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 or 𝟑𝟑(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏) ≥ 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 4. 𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐 ≥ 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 and 𝟑𝟑𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏 < 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
10. If inequalities question 8 were joined by “and” instead of “or,” what would the solution set become?
11. If the inequalities in question 9 were joined by “or” instead of “and,” what would the solution set become?
Student Outcomes
Students learn that equations of the form (𝑥𝑥 − 𝑎𝑎)(𝑥𝑥 − 𝑏𝑏) = 0 have the same solution set as two equations
joined by “or:” 𝑥𝑥 − 𝑎𝑎 = 0 or 𝑥𝑥 − 𝑏𝑏 = 0. Students solve factored or easily factorable equations.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (5 minutes)
Allow students a few minutes to complete only (a) through (d) of Exercise 1, either individually or in pairs.
Exercise 1
a. 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟎𝟎
{𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏}
𝒙𝒙
b. + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟎𝟎
𝟐𝟐
{−𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒}
c. Demanding Dwight insists that you give him two solutions to the following equation:
𝒙𝒙
(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) � + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐� = 𝟎𝟎
𝟐𝟐
Can you provide him with two solutions?
{𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, −𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒}
MP.7
& d. Demanding Dwight now wants FIVE solutions to the following equation:
MP.8 𝒙𝒙
(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏)(𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟔𝟔)(𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑)(𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) � + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐� = 𝟎𝟎
𝟐𝟐
Can you provide him with five solutions?
Discussion (5 minutes)
If I told you that the product of two numbers is 20, could you tell me anything about the two numbers?
Would the numbers have to be 4 and 5?
Would both numbers have to be smaller than 20?
Would they both have to be positive?
Is there much at all you could say about the two numbers.
Not really. They have to have the same sign is about all we can say.
If I told you that the product of two numbers is zero, could you tell me anything about the two numbers?
At least one of the numbers must be zero.
MP.7
& How could we phrase this mathematically?
MP.8
If 𝑎𝑎𝑎𝑎 = 0, then either 𝑎𝑎 = 0 or 𝑏𝑏 = 0 or 𝑎𝑎 = 𝑏𝑏 = 0.
This is known as the zero-product property.
What if the product of three numbers is zero? What if the product of seven numbers is zero?
If any product of numbers is zero, at least one of the terms in that product is zero.
{−𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒}
Example 1
{𝟎𝟎, 𝟓𝟓}
Scaffolding:
Example 2 Remind students of the
Solve 𝒙𝒙(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑) + 𝟓𝟓(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑) = 𝟎𝟎, for 𝒙𝒙. practice of applying the
distribution property
{−𝟓𝟓, 𝟑𝟑}
“backwards” that they saw
in the Lesson 6 Problem Set.
Lead a discussion about the application of the distributive property, in the form of This practice is called
factoring.
factoring polynomial expressions, when solving the equations in these two examples.
MP.6 Students may want to divide both sides by 𝑥𝑥. Remind them that 𝑥𝑥 is an unknown quantity that could be positive,
negative, or zero. These cases need to be handled separately to get the correct answer. Here we will take a more
familiar approach in the solution process, factoring.
Continue to emphasize the idea of rewriting the factored equation as a compound statement. Do not let students skip
this step!
Exercises 2–7
5. (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟒𝟒)(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟔𝟔)(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) = 𝟎𝟎 6. 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 = 𝟎𝟎 7. 𝒙𝒙(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟓𝟓) + 𝟒𝟒(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟓𝟓) = 𝟎𝟎
Example 3 (3 minutes)
Example 3
𝟏𝟏
Consider the equation (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐)(𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟑𝟑) = (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓). Lulu chooses to multiply through by and gets the
𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐
answer 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟖𝟖. But Poindexter points out that 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐 is also an answer, which Lulu missed.
Exercises 8–11
8. Use factoring to solve the equation for 𝒙𝒙: (𝒙𝒙 – 𝟐𝟐)(𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 – 𝟑𝟑) = (𝒙𝒙 – 𝟐𝟐)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏).
{𝟐𝟐, 𝟒𝟒}
10.
a. Verify: (𝒂𝒂 − 𝟓𝟓)(𝒂𝒂 + 𝟓𝟓) = 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. b. Verify: (𝒙𝒙 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖)(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖) = 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟐𝟐.
𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 + 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟐𝟐 = 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟐𝟐
𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
𝒂𝒂 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝒂𝒂 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟐𝟐 = 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟐𝟐
d. Solve for 𝒙𝒙: 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟗𝟗 = 𝟓𝟓(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑). e. Solve for 𝒘𝒘: (𝒘𝒘 + 𝟐𝟐)(𝒘𝒘 − 𝟓𝟓) = 𝒘𝒘𝟐𝟐 − 𝟒𝟒.
11. A string 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 inches long is to be laid out on a table-top to make a rectangle of perimeter 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 inches. Write the width
of the rectangle as 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙 inches. What is an expression for its length? What is an expression for its area? What
value for 𝒙𝒙 gives an area of largest possible value? Describe the shape of the rectangle for this special value of 𝒙𝒙.
The largest area is when 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟎𝟎. In this case, the rectangle is a square with length and width both equal to 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
Closing (3 minutes)
Elicit student responses. Students should make notes of responses in the Lesson Summary rectangle.
If the product of 4 numbers is zero, what do we know about the numbers? At least one of them must equal 0.
What is the danger of dividing both sides of an equation by a variable factor? What should be done instead?
Lesson Summary
The zero-product property says that if 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 = 𝟎𝟎, then either 𝒂𝒂 = 𝟎𝟎 or 𝒃𝒃 = 𝟎𝟎 or 𝒂𝒂 = 𝒃𝒃 = 𝟎𝟎.
Exit Ticket
2. Determine if each statement is true or false. If the statement is false, explain why or show work proving that it is
false.
a. If 𝑎𝑎 = 5, then 𝑎𝑎𝑎𝑎 = 5𝑐𝑐.
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑(𝒙𝒙 + 𝟗𝟗) = 𝟎𝟎
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 = 𝟎𝟎 or 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟗𝟗 = 𝟎𝟎
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟎𝟎 or 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟗𝟗
2. Determine if each statement is true or false. If the statement is false, explain why or show work proving that it is
false.
a. If 𝒂𝒂 = 𝟓𝟓, then 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 = 𝟓𝟓𝒄𝒄.
True.
𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 = 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 = 𝟎𝟎
𝒄𝒄(𝒂𝒂 − 𝟓𝟓) = 𝟎𝟎
𝒄𝒄 = 𝟎𝟎 or 𝒂𝒂 − 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟎𝟎
𝒄𝒄 = 𝟎𝟎 or 𝒂𝒂 = 𝟓𝟓
{𝟎𝟎, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏}
3. Solve (𝒑𝒑 + 𝟑𝟑)(𝒑𝒑 − 𝟓𝟓) = 𝟐𝟐(𝒑𝒑 + 𝟑𝟑), for 𝒑𝒑. What solution do you lose if you simply divide by 𝒑𝒑 + 𝟑𝟑 to get 𝒑𝒑 − 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟐𝟐?
𝒑𝒑 = −𝟑𝟑 or 𝒑𝒑 = 𝟕𝟕. The lost solution is 𝒑𝒑 = −𝟑𝟑. We assumed 𝒑𝒑 + 𝟑𝟑 was not zero when we divided by 𝒑𝒑 + 𝟑𝟑;
therefore, our solution was only complete for 𝒑𝒑 values not equal to −𝟑𝟑.
4. The square of a number plus 3 times the number is equal to 𝟒𝟒. What is the number?
5. In the right triangle shown below, the length of side AB is 𝒙𝒙, the length of side BC is 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐, and the length of the
hypotenuse AC is 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟒𝟒. Use this information to find the length of each side. (Use the Pythagorean Theorem to get
an equation, and solve for 𝒙𝒙.)
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to get the equation 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐)𝟐𝟐 = (𝒙𝒙 + 𝟒𝟒)𝟐𝟐 . This is
equivalent to 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟎𝟎, and the solutions are −𝟐𝟐 and 𝟔𝟔. Choose 𝟔𝟔 since 𝒙𝒙
represents a length, and the lengths are
AB: 𝟔𝟔
BC: 𝟖𝟖
AC: 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
6. Using what you learned in this lesson, create an equation that has 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 and 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 as its only solutions.
(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐)(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓) = 𝟎𝟎
Student Outcomes
1 1
Students interpret equations like = 3 as two equations “ = 3” and “𝑥𝑥 ≠ 0” joined by “and.” Students find
𝑥𝑥 𝑥𝑥
the solution set for this new system of equations.
Classwork
Opening Exercise (5 minutes)
Allow students time to complete the warm up and then discuss the results.
Opening Exercise
Nolan says that he checks the answer to a division problem by performing multiplication. For example, he says that 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 ÷
𝟑𝟑 𝟏𝟏
𝟒𝟒 = 𝟓𝟓 is correct because 𝟓𝟓 × 𝟒𝟒 is 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, and 𝟏𝟏 = 𝟔𝟔 is correct because 𝟔𝟔 × is 𝟑𝟑.
�𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
a. Using Nolan’s reasoning, explain why there is no real number that is the answer to the division problem 𝟓𝟓 ÷ 𝟎𝟎.
𝟎𝟎
b. Quentin says that = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. What do you think?
𝟎𝟎
𝟎𝟎
MP.3 While it is true that 𝟎𝟎 × 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟎𝟎, the problem is that by that principle could equal any number.
𝟎𝟎
𝟓𝟓
c. Mavis says that the expression has a meaningful value for whatever value one chooses to assign to 𝒙𝒙. Do
𝒙𝒙+𝟐𝟐
you agree?
No, the expression does not have a meaningful value when 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟐𝟐.
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑−𝟔𝟔
d. Bernoit says that the expression always has the value 𝟑𝟑 for whichever value one assigns to 𝒙𝒙. Do you
𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐
agree?
0
Note that the problem with is that too many numbers pass Nolan’s criterion! Have students change 17 to a different
0
5
number. It still passes Nolan’s multiplication check. Like , it is a problematic notion. For this reason, we want to
0
disallow the possibility of ever dividing by zero.
5
Point out that an expression like is really accompanied with the clause “under the assumption the denominator is
𝑥𝑥+2
5
not zero.” So, should be read as a compound statement:
𝑥𝑥+2
5 5
and 𝑥𝑥 + 2 ≠ 0 OR and 𝑥𝑥 ≠ −2
𝑥𝑥+2 𝑥𝑥+2
𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 −𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
2. Consider .
(𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 −𝟗𝟗)(𝒙𝒙+𝟒𝟒)
a. Is it permissible to let 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟓𝟓 in this expression?
𝟎𝟎
Yes, = 𝟎𝟎.
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
c. Give all the values of 𝒙𝒙 that are not permissible in this expression.
Example 1
𝟏𝟏 𝟑𝟑
Consider the equation = .
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐
b. Solve the equation for 𝒙𝒙, excluding the value(s) of 𝒙𝒙 that lead to a denominator of zero.
Example 2
𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑 𝟓𝟓
Consider the equation =
𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐 𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐
a. Rewrite the equation into a system of equations.
𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑 𝟓𝟓
= and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐 𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐
b. Solve the equation for 𝒙𝒙, excluding the value(s) of 𝒙𝒙 that lead to a denominator of zero.
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟐𝟐 solution set: ∅
Emphasize the process of recognizing a rational equation as a system composed of the equation itself and the excluded
value(s) of 𝑥𝑥. For Example 1, this is really the compound statement:
1 3
= and 𝑥𝑥 ≠ 0 and 𝑥𝑥 − 2 ≠ 0
𝑥𝑥 𝑥𝑥−2
By the properties of equality, we can multiply through by non-zero quantities. Within this compound
statement, 𝑥𝑥 and 𝑥𝑥 − 2 are nonzero, so we may write 𝑥𝑥 − 2 = 3𝑥𝑥 and 𝑥𝑥 ≠ 0 and 𝑥𝑥 − 2 ≠ 0, which is
equivalent to −2 = 2𝑥𝑥 and 𝑥𝑥 ≠ 0 and 𝑥𝑥 ≠ 2.
All three declarations in this compound statement are true for 𝑥𝑥 = −1. This is the solution set.
In Example 2, remind students of the previous lesson on solving equations involving factored expressions. Students will
need to factor out the common factor and then apply the zero-product property.
What happens in Example 2 when we have 𝑥𝑥 = 2 and 𝑥𝑥 ≠ 2? Both declarations cannot be true. What can we
say about the solution set of the equation?
There is no solution.
Exercises 3–11
Rewrite each equation into a system of equations excluding the value(s) of 𝒙𝒙 that lead to a denominator of zero; then,
solve the equation for 𝒙𝒙.
𝟓𝟓 𝟏𝟏 𝒙𝒙
3. = 𝟏𝟏 4. = 𝟑𝟑 5. = 𝟒𝟒
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙−𝟓𝟓 𝒙𝒙+𝟏𝟏
𝟓𝟓 𝟏𝟏 𝒙𝒙
= 𝟏𝟏 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟎𝟎 = 𝟑𝟑 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟒𝟒 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ −𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙−𝟓𝟓 𝒙𝒙+𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟒𝟒
{𝟓𝟓} � � �− �
𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑
𝟐𝟐 𝟑𝟑 𝒙𝒙 𝟔𝟔 𝒙𝒙−𝟑𝟑
6. = 7. =− 8. = 𝟎𝟎
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙−𝟒𝟒 𝒙𝒙+𝟔𝟔 𝒙𝒙+𝟔𝟔 𝒙𝒙+𝟐𝟐
𝟐𝟐 𝟑𝟑 𝒙𝒙 𝟔𝟔 𝒙𝒙−𝟑𝟑
= and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟎𝟎 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟒𝟒 =− and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ −𝟔𝟔 = 𝟎𝟎 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ −𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙−𝟒𝟒 𝒙𝒙+𝟔𝟔 𝒙𝒙+𝟔𝟔 𝒙𝒙+𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑 𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑
9. = 𝟓𝟓 10. = 𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑 𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑
𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑 𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑
= 𝟓𝟓 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ −𝟑𝟑 = 𝟏𝟏 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ −𝟑𝟑
𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑 𝒙𝒙+𝟑𝟑
11. A baseball player’s batting average is calculated by dividing the number of times a player got a hit by the total
number of times the player was at bat. It is expressed as a decimal rounded to three places. After the first ten
games of the season, Samuel had 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 hits off of 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 “at bats.”
a. What is his batting average after the first ten games?
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
≈ 𝟎𝟎 . 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
b. How many hits in a row would he need to get to raise his batting average to above 𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓?
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒙𝒙
> 𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒙𝒙
𝒙𝒙 > 𝟗𝟗
c. How many “at bats” in a row without a hit would result in his batting average dropping below 𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑?
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
< 𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒙𝒙
𝒙𝒙 > 𝟕𝟕
If he went 𝟖𝟖 “at bats” in a row without a hit, he would be below 𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑.
Ask:
What was the difference between Exercises 9 and 10? How did that affect the solution set?
Work through Exercises 11 as a class.
Closing (5 minutes)
Ask these questions after going over the exercises.
When an equation has a variable in the denominator, what must be considered?
When the solution to the equation is also an excluded value of 𝑥𝑥, then what is the solution set to the equation?
Exit Ticket
𝑥𝑥−2
1. Rewrite the equation = 2 as a system of equations. Then, solve for 𝑥𝑥.
𝑥𝑥−9
𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐
1. Rewrite the equation = 𝟐𝟐 as a system of equations. Then, solve for 𝒙𝒙.
𝒙𝒙−𝟗𝟗
𝒙𝒙−𝟐𝟐
= 𝟐𝟐 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟗𝟗
𝒙𝒙−𝟗𝟗
𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐(𝒙𝒙 − 𝟗𝟗)
𝒙𝒙 − 𝟐𝟐 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝒙𝒙
{𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏}
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏�𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 −𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒�
1. Consider the equation = 𝟎𝟎. Is 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟕𝟕 permissible? Which values of 𝒙𝒙 are excluded? Rewrite as a
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑�𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 −𝟒𝟒�(𝒙𝒙+𝟏𝟏)
system of equations.
Yes, 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟕𝟕 is permissible. The excluded values are 𝟎𝟎, ±𝟐𝟐, and −𝟏𝟏. The system is
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏�𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 −𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒�
= 𝟎𝟎 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟎𝟎 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ −𝟐𝟐 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ −𝟏𝟏 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟐𝟐.
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑�𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 −𝟒𝟒�(𝒙𝒙+𝟏𝟏)
2. Rewrite each equation as a system of equations excluding the value(s) of 𝒙𝒙 that lead to a denominator of zero. Then
solve the equation for 𝒙𝒙.
𝟏𝟏
a. 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 =
𝒙𝒙
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
System: 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟎𝟎; solution set: �± �
𝒙𝒙 𝟓𝟓
𝟏𝟏
b. = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
System: = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟎𝟎; solution set: � �
𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
𝒙𝒙
c. = 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙
𝟕𝟕−𝒙𝒙
𝒙𝒙 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
System: = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟕𝟕; solution set: �𝟎𝟎, 𝟐𝟐 �
𝟕𝟕−𝒙𝒙
𝟐𝟐 𝟓𝟓
d. =
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙+𝟏𝟏
𝟐𝟐 𝟓𝟓 𝟐𝟐
System: = and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ −𝟏𝟏 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟎𝟎; solution set: � �
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙+𝟏𝟏 𝟑𝟑
𝟑𝟑+𝒙𝒙 𝟑𝟑+𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙
e. =
𝟑𝟑−𝒙𝒙 𝟑𝟑−𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙
𝟑𝟑+𝒙𝒙 𝟑𝟑+𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 𝟑𝟑
System: = and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟑𝟑; solution set: {𝟎𝟎}
𝟑𝟑−𝒙𝒙 𝟑𝟑−𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
3. Ross wants to cut a 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒-foot rope into two pieces so that the length of the first piece divided by the length of the
second piece is 𝟐𝟐.
a. Let 𝒙𝒙 represent the length of the first piece. Write an equation that represents the relationship between the
pieces as stated above.
𝒙𝒙
= 𝟐𝟐
𝟒𝟒𝟎𝟎 − 𝒙𝒙
b. What values of 𝒙𝒙 are not permissible in this equation? Describe within the context of the problem, what
situation is occurring if 𝒙𝒙 were to equal this value(s). Rewrite as a system of equations to exclude the value(s).
𝒙𝒙
𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 is not a permissible value because it would mean the rope is still intact. System: = 𝟐𝟐 and 𝒙𝒙 ≠ 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒−𝒙𝒙
c. Solve the equation to obtain the lengths of the two pieces of rope. (Round to the nearest tenth if necessary.)
𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
First piece is ≈ 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. 𝟕𝟕 feet long; second piece is ≈ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. 𝟑𝟑 feet long.
𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑
Student Outcomes
Students learn to think of some of the letters in a formula as constants in order to define a relationship
between two or more quantities, where one is in terms of another, for example holding 𝑉𝑉 in 𝑉𝑉 = 𝐼𝐼𝐼𝐼 as
constant, and finding 𝑅𝑅 in terms of 𝐼𝐼.
Classwork Scaffolding:
Before starting the warm-
Provide an introduction to the lesson:
up, ask students to read
Formulas that relate two or more variable symbols such as 𝐴𝐴 = 𝑙𝑙𝑙𝑙, 𝐷𝐷 = 𝑟𝑟𝑟𝑟, or the introduction and
𝑎𝑎2 + 𝑏𝑏 2 = 𝑐𝑐 2 arise in different applications of mathematics, science, and other discuss other formulas
areas of study. These formulas have meaning based on a situation. they have seen in previous
grades.
However, even without an applied setting, formulas can stand on their own as a
relationship between variables. As students work the
warm-up and first few
You can use the equation-solving techniques from earlier lessons to rearrange
exercises, adjust the
formulas and solve for a specific variable symbol.
pacing depending on how
well students are doing
Exercise 1 (5 minutes) with Exercises 1(c) and 3.
Have students work independently. Monitor their progress on part (c) and have them review and correct their solutions
with a partner.
Exercise 1
Solve each equation for 𝒙𝒙. For part (c), remember a variable symbol, like 𝒂𝒂, 𝒃𝒃, and 𝒄𝒄, represents a number.
a. 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟔𝟔 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 b. −𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 − 𝟑𝟑 = −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 c. 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 − 𝒃𝒃 = 𝒄𝒄
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟖𝟖 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟑𝟑 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 − 𝒃𝒃 = 𝒄𝒄
𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 = 𝒃𝒃 + 𝒄𝒄
𝒃𝒃 + 𝒄𝒄
𝒙𝒙 =
𝒂𝒂
Exercise 2
Compare your work in parts (a) through (c) above. Did you have to do anything differently to solve for 𝒙𝒙 in part (c)?
Exercise 3
Solve the equation 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 − 𝒃𝒃 = 𝒄𝒄 for 𝒂𝒂. The variable symbols 𝒙𝒙, 𝒃𝒃, and 𝒄𝒄 represent numbers.
𝒃𝒃+𝒄𝒄
Solving for a is the same process as solving for 𝒙𝒙. 𝒂𝒂 =
𝒙𝒙
Debrief student responses to Exercises 2 and 3 as a whole class. Make sure to emphasize the points below.
Variables are placeholders for numbers and as such have the same properties.
When solving an equation with several variables, you use the same properties and reasoning as with single-
variable equations.
The equation in Exercise 3 holds as long as 𝑥𝑥 does not equal 0 (division by 0 is undefined). Consider your result
from Exercise 1(c). Does this equation hold for all values of the variables involved?
No, it only holds if 𝑎𝑎 ≠ 0.
The area 𝑨𝑨 of a rectangle is 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 in2. The formula for area is 𝑨𝑨 = 𝒍𝒍𝒍𝒍.
Verify that the area formula, solved for 𝒍𝒍, will give the same results for 𝒍𝒍 as having solved for 𝒍𝒍 in the original
area formula.
𝑨𝑨 = 𝒍𝒍𝒍𝒍
𝑨𝑨 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 𝟓𝟓
𝒍𝒍 = = =
𝒘𝒘 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐
𝑨𝑨 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 𝟓𝟓
𝒍𝒍 = = =
𝒘𝒘 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟑𝟑
Walk students through the solution to this problem. Have them write the reasons for each step in the equation solving
process on their paper. Much of the work students will do in future classes will involve rearranging formulas to highlight
MP.3 a variable of interest. Begin to set the stage that solving for a variable before you plug in values is often easier than
solving after you substitute the values, especially when the numbers are not user-friendly. If time permits, give them
3
𝐴𝐴 = 10.356 and 𝑤𝑤 = 5 and ask them to solve for the length.
11
Exercise 4 (7 minutes)
Have students work in small groups or with a partner. Solving these exercises two ways will help students to further
understand that rearranging a formula with variables involves the same reasoning as solving an equation for a single
variable.
Exercise 4
Solve each problem two ways. First, substitute the given values and solve for the given variable. Then, solve for the
given variable and substitute the given values.
a. The perimeter formula for a rectangle is 𝒑𝒑 = 𝟐𝟐(𝒍𝒍 + 𝒘𝒘), where 𝒑𝒑 represents the perimeter, 𝒍𝒍 represents the length,
and 𝒘𝒘 represents the width. Calculate 𝒍𝒍 when 𝒑𝒑 = 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 and 𝒘𝒘 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
Sample responses:
Substitute and solve. 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 = 𝟐𝟐(𝒍𝒍 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏), 𝒍𝒍 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝒑𝒑
Solve for the variable first: 𝒍𝒍 = − 𝒘𝒘
𝟐𝟐
𝟏𝟏
b. The area formula for a triangle is 𝑨𝑨 = 𝒃𝒃𝒃𝒃, where 𝑨𝑨 represents the area, 𝒃𝒃 represents the length of the base, and 𝒉𝒉
𝟐𝟐
represents the height. Calculate 𝒃𝒃 when 𝑨𝑨 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and 𝒉𝒉 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐.
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝒃𝒃 = , 𝒃𝒃 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝒉𝒉
Have one or two students present their solutions to the entire class.
Exercise 5 (7 minutes)
The next set of exercises increases slightly in difficulty. Instead of substituting, students solve for the requested variable.
Have students continue to work in groups or with a partner. If the class seems to be getting stuck, solve part of one
exercise as a whole class and then have them go back to working with their partner or group.
Have students present their results to the entire class. Look for valid solution methods that arrive at the same answer
using a slightly different process to isolate the variable. For part (b–ii), students may need a reminder to use the square
root to “undo” the square of a number. They learned about square roots and solving simple quadratic equations in
Grade 8.
Exercise 5
Rearrange each formula to solve for the specified variable. Assume no variable is equal to 𝟎𝟎.
𝟏𝟏
b. Given 𝑲𝑲 = 𝒎𝒎𝒗𝒗𝟐𝟐 ,
𝟐𝟐
i. Solve for 𝒎𝒎.
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝒎𝒎 =
𝒗𝒗𝟐𝟐
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝒗𝒗 = ±�
𝒎𝒎
Closing (2 minutes)
Review the Lesson Summary and close with these questions.
How is rearranging formulas the same as solving equations that contain a single variable symbol?
How is rearranging formulas different from solving equations that contain a single variable symbol?
As you wrap up, make sure students understand that while there is essentially no difference when rearranging formulas,
it may seem more difficult and the final answers may appear more complicated because you cannot combine the
variables into a single numerical expression like you can when you add, subtract, multiply, or divide numbers in the
course of solving a typical equation.
Lesson Summary
The properties and reasoning used to solve equations apply regardless of how many variables appear in an
equation or formula. Rearranging formulas to solve for a specific variable can be useful when solving applied
problems.
Exit Ticket
1+𝑎𝑎
Given the formula 𝑥𝑥 = ,
1−𝑎𝑎
𝟏𝟏+𝒂𝒂
Given the formula = ,
𝟏𝟏−𝒂𝒂
𝒙𝒙+𝒃𝒃
1. 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 + 𝟑𝟑𝒃𝒃 = 𝟐𝟐𝒇𝒇 2. 𝒓𝒓𝒓𝒓 + 𝒉𝒉 = 𝒔𝒔𝒔𝒔 − 𝒌𝒌 3. 𝟑𝟑𝒑𝒑𝒑𝒑 = 𝟐𝟐𝒒𝒒(𝒓𝒓 − 𝟓𝟓𝒙𝒙) 4. = 𝒄𝒄
𝟒𝟒
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 𝒉𝒉 + 𝒌𝒌 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙 = 𝒙𝒙 = 𝒙𝒙 = 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝒃𝒃
𝒂𝒂 𝒔𝒔 − 𝒓𝒓 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 𝒙𝒙 𝟏𝟏 𝟑𝟑𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂+𝟐𝟐𝒃𝒃
5. − 𝟕𝟕 = 𝟐𝟐𝒒𝒒 6. − = 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 7. − = 8. = 𝟒𝟒𝒅𝒅
𝟓𝟓 𝟔𝟔 𝟕𝟕 𝒎𝒎 𝒏𝒏 𝒑𝒑 𝒄𝒄
𝒏𝒏𝒏𝒏 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 𝒙𝒙 = 𝒙𝒙 =
(𝒏𝒏 − 𝒎𝒎)𝒑𝒑 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
9. Solve for 𝒎𝒎. 10. Solve for 𝒖𝒖. 11. Solve for 𝒔𝒔. 12. Solve for 𝒉𝒉.
𝒎𝒎𝒎𝒎 𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝑨𝑨 = 𝒔𝒔𝟐𝟐 𝑽𝑽 = 𝝅𝝅𝒓𝒓𝟐𝟐 𝒉𝒉
𝒕𝒕 = + =
𝒎𝒎 + 𝒏𝒏 𝒖𝒖 𝒗𝒗 𝒇𝒇
𝒏𝒏𝒏𝒏 𝒗𝒗𝒗𝒗 𝑽𝑽
𝒎𝒎 = 𝒖𝒖 = 𝒔𝒔 = ±√𝑨𝑨 𝒉𝒉 =
𝒔𝒔 − 𝒕𝒕 𝒗𝒗 − 𝒇𝒇 𝝅𝝅𝒓𝒓𝟐𝟐
13. Solve for 𝒎𝒎. 14. Solve for 𝒅𝒅. 15. Solve for 𝒚𝒚. 16. Solve for 𝒃𝒃𝟏𝟏 .
𝑻𝑻 = 𝟒𝟒√𝒎𝒎 𝒎𝒎𝒎𝒎 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 + 𝒃𝒃𝒃𝒃 = 𝒄𝒄 𝟏𝟏
𝑭𝑭 = 𝑮𝑮 𝟐𝟐 𝑨𝑨 = 𝒉𝒉(𝒃𝒃𝟏𝟏 + 𝒃𝒃𝟐𝟐 )
𝒅𝒅 𝟐𝟐
𝑻𝑻𝟐𝟐 𝑮𝑮𝑮𝑮𝑮𝑮 𝒄𝒄 − 𝒂𝒂𝒂𝒂 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
𝒎𝒎 = 𝒅𝒅 = ±� 𝒚𝒚 = 𝒃𝒃𝟏𝟏 = − 𝒃𝒃𝟐𝟐
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝑭𝑭 𝒃𝒃 𝒉𝒉
17. The science teacher wrote three equations on a board that relate velocity, 𝒗𝒗, distance traveled, 𝒅𝒅, and the time to
travel the distance, 𝒕𝒕, on the board.
𝒅𝒅 𝒅𝒅
𝒗𝒗 = 𝒕𝒕 = 𝒅𝒅 = 𝒗𝒗𝒗𝒗
𝒕𝒕 𝒗𝒗
Would you need to memorize all three equations or could you just memorize one? Explain your reasoning.
You could just memorize 𝒅𝒅 = 𝒗𝒗𝒗𝒗 since the other two equations are obtained from this one by solving for 𝒗𝒗 and 𝒕𝒕.
Student Outcomes
Students recognize and identify solutions to two-variable equations. They represent the solution set
graphically. They create two variable equations to represent a situation. They understand that the graph of
the line 𝑎𝑥 + 𝑏𝑦 = 𝑐 is a visual representation of the solution set to the equation 𝑎𝑥 + 𝑏𝑦 = 𝑐.
Classwork
Scaffolding:
Open the lesson with the following:
Circulate to make sure
When working with equations that contain more than one variable, there is students are substituting
often more than one solution. Solutions can be represented using ordered pairs the first coordinate for 𝑥
when the equation contains two variables. All of the solutions to an equation and the second one for 𝑦.
are called the solution set. Create a class graph using
What do we know about the graph of equations of the form 𝑎𝑥 + 𝑏𝑦 = 𝑐? a sheet of poster paper
and give each student a
We know from Grade 8, the graph of 𝑎𝑥 + 𝑏𝑦 = 𝑐 is a line.
sticky dot. Have them
write the solution on the
sticky dot and post theirs
Exercise 1 (5 minutes) on the class graph. They
can correct errors when
Exercise 1 their solution is not on the
a. Circle all the ordered pairs (𝒙, 𝒚) that are solutions to the equation 𝟒𝒙 − 𝒚 = 𝟏𝟎. line.
b. How did you decide whether or not an ordered pair was a solution to the equation?
Most students will explain that they substituted and checked to see whether or not the equation was true.
Point out the two-variable equation in Exercise 1 and the possible solutions represented as ordered pairs. Working
independently, students use their prior knowledge to verify which ordered pairs are solutions to an equation. Ask
students to compare their solutions with a partner. Briefly share answers and give students a chance to revise their
work or add to their written response to part (b).
Exercise 2
a. Discover as many additional solutions to the equation 𝟒𝒙 − 𝒚 = 𝟏𝟎 as possible. Consider the best way to
organize all the solutions you have found. Be prepared to share the strategies you used to find your
solutions.
b. Now, find five more solutions where one or more variables are negative numbers or non-integer values. Be
prepared to share the strategies you used to find your solutions.
𝟏 𝟑 𝟓
Sample answers: (−𝟒, −𝟐𝟔); (−𝟑, −𝟐𝟐); ( , −𝟖); ( , −𝟒); ( , 𝟎)
𝟐 𝟐 𝟐
c. How many ordered pairs (𝒙, 𝒚) will be in the solution set of the
equation 𝟒𝒙 − 𝒚 = 𝟏𝟎?
Infinitely many.
e. Why does it make sense to represent the solution to the equation 𝟒𝒙 − 𝒚 = 𝟏𝟎 as a line in the coordinate
plane?
Drawing the line is the only way to include all possible solutions. It would be impossible to plot every point
that is a solution to the equation since there are infinitely many solutions.
Next, have the groups complete parts (b) through (d). Debrief the entire class by having each group share their work, or
if time permits, create a class graph. Parts (c) and (e) are the most important. Students need to realize that listing all the
solutions is impossible. A visual representation of a curve (in this case a line) is a way to include ALL possible solutions
including those with fractional or irrational values. You could prove this to students by letting 𝑥 = √2 and then solving
for 𝑦 = 4√2 − 10. Then use a graphing calculator or graphing software to graph the line and find the value when 𝑥 =
√2.
Exercise 3–5
b. List at least six solutions to the equation you created in part (a).
4. Gia had 𝟐𝟓 songs in a playlist composed of songs from her two favorite artists, Beyonce and Jennifer Lopez. How
many songs did she have by each one in the playlist?
a. Create an equation using two variables to represent this situation. Be sure to explain the meaning of each
variable.
Let 𝒙 = the number of Beyonce songs, and let 𝒚 = the number of Jennifer Lopez songs. Equation: 𝒙 + 𝒚 = 𝟐𝟓
5. Compare your solutions to Exercises 3 and 4. How are they alike? How are they different?
The solution set to Exercise 3 is an infinite number of ordered pairs, and the graph is a solid line. The solution set to
Exercise 4 is a finite set of ordered pairs that also happens to be in the solution set to Exercise 3. The graph is a
discrete set of points that lie on the line 𝒚 = −𝒙 + 𝟐𝟓.
When you debrief these exercises with the whole class, be sure to reinforce that the domain depends on the situation.
Review expectations for making a complete graph (scaling, labeling, etc.). Emphasize the difference between a discrete
and continuous graph.
Closing (5 minutes)
Review the lesson summary by reading closely and posing the questions below.
Is the graph of the line 𝑦 = 2𝑥 − 3 the same as the solution set to the equation 𝑦 = 2𝑥 − 3? Explain your
reasoning.
Yes. According to the lesson summary, the set of (𝑥, 𝑦) points that forms the solution set will be points
on the graph. Since the degree of 𝑥 and 𝑦 are both one, the resulting graph is a line.
Suppose I am using the equation to represent the following context: The number of trucks manufactured is
always 3 fewer than twice the number of cars manufactured. Does it still make sense that every point on the
line is a solution to my equation considering the context of my problem?
No, only the points (𝑥, 𝑦) that are in the domain of whole numbers (since they don’t manufacture 0.3 of
a car or truck) are solutions to the equation within this context.
Why is it useful to represent the solutions to a two-variable equation using a graph?
If the domain of 𝑥 and 𝑦 are the real numbers, then it would be impossible to list all of the solutions as
ordered pairs. A continuous graph implies that every 𝑥-value in the domain of the graph has a
corresponding 𝑦-value that makes the equation true.
Even if the domain of 𝑥 and 𝑦 are integers or whole numbers or something other than the real numbers,
it is helpful to extend a line along all the solution points and use that line to find other solutions within
the domain (much more so than trying to draw out a bunch of dots along the ruler).
It is also cool and convenient that the graph of each class of equation has a distinctive shape on the
𝑥–𝑦 plane. The graphs of equations are usually visually striking and telling in a very efficient way. As
we learn in future lessons, the 2-variable version of inequalities, solutions, systems, etc., each carries an
interesting geometrical meaning in its 2D graph.
Lesson Summary
An ordered pair is a solution to a two variable equation when each number substituted into its corresponding
variable makes the equation a true-number sentence. All of the solutions to a two-variable equation are called the
solution set.
Each ordered pair of numbers in the solution set of the equation corresponds to a point on the coordinate plane.
The set of all such points in the coordinate plane is called the graph of the equation.
Exit Ticket
The Math Club sells hot dogs at a school fundraiser. The club earns $108 and has a combination of five-dollar and one-
dollar bills in its cash box. Possible combinations of bills are listed in the table below. Complete the table.
16 28
11 53
4 88
1. Find one more combination of ones and fives that totals $108.
3. What is the meaning of the variables (𝑥 and 𝑦) and the numbers (1, 5,
and 108) in the equation 5𝑥 + 1𝑦 = 108?
The Math Club sells hot dogs at a school fundraiser. The club earns $𝟏𝟎𝟖 and has a combination of five-dollar and one-
dollar bills in its cash box. Possible combinations of bills are listed in the table below. Complete the table.
1. Find one more combination of ones and fives that totals $𝟏𝟎𝟖.
(𝟐𝟎, 𝟖), which stands for 𝟐𝟎 fives and 𝟖 ones.
Justifications will vary. Sample response: I identified points on each graph and substituted them into the equations.
Some graphs had the same points like (𝟎, −𝟔), so I needed to check the solutions with at least one other point.
a. 𝒚 = 𝟓𝒙 − 𝟔
1 2
Graph 4
b. 𝒙 + 𝟐𝒚 = −𝟏𝟐
Graph 5
c. 𝟐𝒙 + 𝒚 = 𝟒
Graph 1
d. 𝒚 = 𝟑𝒙 − 𝟔
Graph 3
e. 𝒙 = −𝒚 − 𝟒
Graph 2
3 4 5
2. Graph the solution set in the coordinate plane. Label at least two ordered pairs that are solutions on your graph.
Graph a Graph b
(4,10)
(2,39)
(10,0) (0,20)
Graph c Graph d
3. Mari and Lori are starting a business to make gourmet toffee. They gather the following information from another
business about prices for different amounts of toffee. Which equation and which graph are most likely to model the
price, 𝒑, for 𝒙 pounds of toffee? Justify your reasoning.
Graph 1 Graph 2
Price 𝒑 for 𝒙
Pounds 𝒙
pounds
𝟎. 𝟐𝟓 $𝟑. 𝟔𝟎
𝟎. 𝟖𝟏 $𝟔. 𝟒𝟖
𝟏 $𝟕. 𝟐𝟎
𝟏. 𝟒𝟒 $𝟖. 𝟔𝟒
Equation A: 𝒑 = 𝟓𝒙 + 𝟐. 𝟐
Equation B: 𝒑 = 𝟕. 𝟐√𝒙
Graph 1 is a non-linear function. It fits the table data better and seems to be the correct equation. I estimated a few
ordered pairs on the graph, and they were close matches to the values in the table. The points on the second graph
do not match the table values at all for 𝒙-values larger than 𝟏.
Student Outcomes
Students recognize and identify solutions to two-variable inequalities. They represent the solution set
graphically. They create two-variable inequalities to represent a situation.
Students understand that a half-plane bounded by the line 𝑎𝑎𝑎𝑎 + 𝑏𝑏𝑏𝑏 = 𝑐𝑐 is a visual representation of the
solution set to a linear inequality, such as 𝑎𝑎𝑎𝑎 + 𝑏𝑏𝑏𝑏 < 𝑐𝑐. They interpret the inequality symbol correctly to
determine which portion of the coordinate plane is shaded to represent the solution.
Lesson Notes
Students explore an inequality related to the equation from the previous lesson’s Exercises 1–2. Using the same
equation will help students to distinguish the differences between solution sets and graphs of two-variable equations
versus two-variable inequalities.
Materials
Graph paper
Classwork
Consider opening the lesson with the following:
When working with inequalities in one variable, you learned to graph the solution set on a number line. When
working with inequalities with two variables, the solutions are also represented visually but in two-dimensions
in the coordinate plane.
Exercise 1 (5 minutes)
Discuss the two-variable equation in Exercise 1 and the possible solutions represented as ordered pairs.
Have students work independently, using their prior knowledge to verify which ordered pairs are solutions to an
equation (make a true number sentence).
Exercise 1
a. Circle each ordered pair (𝒙𝒙, 𝒚𝒚) that is a solution to the equation 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 − 𝒚𝒚 ≤ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
i. (𝟑𝟑, 𝟐𝟐) (𝟐𝟐, 𝟑𝟑) (−𝟏𝟏, −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) (𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎) (𝟏𝟏, −𝟔𝟔)
ii. (𝟓𝟓, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) (𝟎𝟎, −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒) (𝟔𝟔, 𝟎𝟎) (𝟒𝟒, −𝟏𝟏)
Ask students to compare their solutions with a partner. Briefly share answers and give students a chance to revise their
work or add to their written response to part (a). Do not linger on part (c); the activity that follows will help to clarify
their thinking.
Scaffolding
Exercise 2 (10 minutes) Pay attention to students who
are still struggling to interpret
Students should work in groups on part (a) only. After about 4 minutes, have each group the inequality symbols
share their solutions and their solution strategies with the entire class. Highlight the correctly. Perhaps creating a
MP.1 different approaches to finding solutions. Most groups will likely start by picking a value chart or adding terms to a
for either 𝑥𝑥 or 𝑦𝑦 and then deciding what the other variable should equal to make the word wall could serve as a
number sentence true. reminder to the students.
Exercise 2
b. Graph the line 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. What do you notice about the solutions
to the inequality 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝒚𝒚 ≤ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and the graph of the line 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏?
All of the points are either on the line or to the left of (or above) the line.
𝒚𝒚 ≥ 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
I observed that all the points were on one side of the line, and then I tested some points on the other side of
the line and found that all the points I tested from that side of the line were not solutions to the inequality.
Next have the groups complete parts (b)–(d). As they work, circulate around the room answering questions and
providing support. Make sure that students reversed the inequality symbol when solving for 𝑦𝑦 in part (c). Discuss the
following:
I noticed some of you wrote that all the points are on the left side of the line and others wrote that all the
points are above the line. Are both of those descriptions correct?
Now, look at your answer to part (c). When you solved the inequality for 𝑦𝑦, what does that statement seem to
tell you?
It tells you all the 𝑦𝑦-values have to be greater than or equal to something related to 𝑥𝑥.
Then which description would you say best correlates to the inequality we wrote in part (c)? Points to the left
of the line or points above the line? Why?
Points above the line because when we solved for 𝑦𝑦, we are describing where the 𝑦𝑦-values are in
relation to the line, and 𝑦𝑦-values are plotted on the vertical axis; therefore, the words above and below
are the accurate descriptors.
How can we depict the entire solution set of ALL the points above the line? When we worked with equations in
one variable and graphed our solution set on the number line, how did we show what the solution set was?
We colored it darker or shaded it. So we can just shade in the entire area above the line.
What about the line itself, is it part of the solution set?
Yes.
What if it wasn’t? What if the inequality was 𝑦𝑦 > 4𝑥𝑥 − 10? How could we show that it is all the points except
that line?
We traditionally make the line a dashed line instead of a solid line to indicate that the points on the line
are not part of the solution set.
Before moving on, make sure students understand that any ordered pair in the solution set will be a point (𝑥𝑥, 𝑦𝑦) that is
located on (or above) the line because that is the portion of the coordinate plane where 𝑦𝑦 is greater than or equal to the
difference of 4𝑥𝑥 and 10.
Example 1
All points below the line should be shaded. The line should be dashed, and all points below the
line should be shaded.
Allow students to debate and discuss. Guide them to the correct conclusion, and then review the definition of a half-
plane that follows Exercise 3, clarifying for students that a strict inequality does not include the or equal to option. It
must be either strictly less than or greater than.
Exercises 3–5
3. Using a separate sheet of graph paper, plot the solution sets to the following equations and inequalities:
a. 𝒙𝒙 − 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 f. 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟓𝟓 k. 𝒙𝒙 > 𝟎𝟎
b. 𝒙𝒙 − 𝒚𝒚 < 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 g. 𝒚𝒚 < 𝟓𝟓 l. 𝒚𝒚 < 𝟎𝟎
c. 𝒚𝒚 > 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 h. 𝒙𝒙 ≥ 𝟓𝟓 m. 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 − 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟎𝟎
d. 𝒚𝒚 ≥ 𝒙𝒙 i. 𝒚𝒚 ≠ 𝟏𝟏 n. 𝒙𝒙𝟐𝟐 + 𝒚𝒚𝟐𝟐 > 𝟎𝟎
e. 𝒙𝒙 ≥ 𝒚𝒚 j. 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟎𝟎 o. 𝒙𝒙𝒙𝒙 ≤ 𝟎𝟎
a–c: Parts (b) and (c) are identical. In part (a), the solution is the graph of the line.
d–e: Both solution sets include the line 𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙. Part (d) is the half-plane above the line, and part (e) is the half-plane
below the line. When debriefing, ask students to share how they approached part (e).
f–i: These exercises focus on vertical and horizontal boundary lines. Emphasis should be placed on the fact that
inequalities like part (h) are shaded to the left or to the right of the vertical line.
j–l: These exercises will help students to understand that 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟎𝟎 is the 𝒚𝒚-axis and 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟎𝟎 is the 𝒙𝒙-axis.
m–o: These exercises can serve as extension questions. For part (m), a curve separates the plane into two regions.
In part (n), the solution is the entire coordinate plane except (𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎). In part (o), the solution is all points in quadrants
2 and 4, including both axes and the origin.
A half-plane is the graph of a solution set in the Cartesian coordinate plane of an inequality in two real number
variables that is linear and strict.
b. 𝒙𝒙 < −𝟓𝟓
The half plane to the left of the vertical line 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟓𝟓, not including the line 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟓𝟓.
c. 𝒚𝒚 ≥ 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 − 𝟓𝟓
The line 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟓𝟓 and the half-plane lying above it.
d. 𝒚𝒚 < 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 − 𝟓𝟓
The half-plane lying below the line 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 − 𝟓𝟓.
5. Graph the solution set to 𝒙𝒙 < −𝟓𝟓, reading it as an inequality in one variable, and describe the solution set in words.
Then graph the solution set to 𝒙𝒙 < −𝟓𝟓 again, this time reading it as an inequality in two variables, and describe the
solution set in words.
Read in one variable: All real numbers less than −𝟓𝟓. The graph will have
an open circle at the endpoint −𝟓𝟓 and extend as a ray to the left of −𝟓𝟓
on the number line.
Read in two variables: All ordered pairs (𝒙𝒙, 𝒚𝒚) such that 𝒙𝒙 is less than
−𝟓𝟓. The graph will be a dashed vertical line through 𝒙𝒙 = −𝟓𝟓, and all
points to the left of the line will be shaded.
Closing (2 minutes)
Why is it useful to represent the solution to an inequality with two variables graphically?
How does graphing the solution set of a one-variable inequality compare to graphing the solution set to a two-
variable inequality?
Lesson Summary
An ordered pair is a solution to a two-variable inequality if, when each number is substituted into its corresponding
variable, it makes the inequality a true number sentence.
Each ordered pair of numbers in the solution set of the inequality corresponds to a point on the coordinate plane.
The set of all such points in the coordinate plane is called the graph of the inequality.
Exit Ticket
What pairs of numbers satisfy the statement: The sum of two numbers is less than 10?
Create an inequality with two variables to represent this situation and graph the solution set.
What pairs of numbers satisfy the statement: The sum of two numbers is less than 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏?
Create an inequality with two variables to represent this situation and graph the solution set.
Graph the line 𝒚𝒚 = −𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 using a dashed line and shade below the line.
a. 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 − 𝒚𝒚 > 𝟔𝟔
Graph 2
b. 𝒚𝒚 ≤ 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 − 𝟔𝟔
Graph 4
c. 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 < 𝒚𝒚 + 𝟔𝟔
Graph 3
d. 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 − 𝟔𝟔 ≤ 𝒚𝒚
Graph 1
I re-arranged each equation and found that they were all the same except for the inequality symbol. The strict
inequalities are the dashed lines, and the others are solid lines. When solved for 𝒚𝒚, you can decide the shading.
Greater than is shaded above the line, and less than is shaded below the line.
2. Graph the solution set in the coordinate plane. Support your answer by selecting two ordered pairs in the solution
set and verifying that they make the inequality true.
Solutions are graphed below for parts (a), (c), and (e).
a. c. e.
3. Marti sells tacos and burritos from a food truck at the farmers market. She sells burritos for $𝟑𝟑. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 each and tacos
for $𝟐𝟐. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 each. She hopes to earn at least $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 at the farmers market this Saturday.
a. Identify three combinations of tacos and burritos that will earn Marti more than $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
Answers will vary. Answers to part (a) should be solutions to the inequality 𝟑𝟑. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
b. Identify three combinations of tacos and burritos that will earn Marti exactly $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
Answers will vary. Answers to part (b) should be solutions to the equation 𝟑𝟑. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
c. Identify three combinations of tacos and burritos that will not earn Marti at least $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
Answers will vary. Answers to part (c) should not be solutions to the inequality or equation.
y
d. Graph your answers to parts (a)–(c) in the coordinate plane and then
shade a half-plane that contains all possible solutions to this problem. 80
70
The graph shown for part (d) is shown to the right. Answers to part (a)
60
should lie in the shaded half-plane. Answers to part (b) should lie on the
line, and answers to part (c) should lie in the un-shaded half-plane. 50
40
30
20
10
0 10 20 30 40 50 x
e. Create a linear inequality that represents the solution to this problem. Let 𝒙𝒙 equal the number of burritos
that Marti sells, and let 𝒚𝒚 equal the number of tacos that Marti sells.
f. Are the points (𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒. 𝟓𝟓) a solution to inequality you created in part (e)? Explain your reasoning.
The point would not be valid because it would not make sense in this situation to sell a fractional amount of
tacos or burritos.
Student Outcomes
Students identify solutions to simultaneous equations or inequalities; they solve systems of linear equations
and inequalities either algebraically or graphically.
Classwork
Opening Exercise (8 minutes)
Allow students time to work on (a)–(d) individually. Then have students compare responses with a partner or share
responses as a class.
Opening Exercise
Consider the following compound sentence: 𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏.
a. Circle all the ordered pairs (𝒙𝒙, 𝒚𝒚) that are solutions to the inequality 𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
b. Underline all the ordered pairs (𝒙𝒙, 𝒚𝒚) that are solutions to the equation 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏.
c. List the ordered pair(s) (𝒙𝒙, 𝒚𝒚) from above that are solutions to the compound sentence 𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and
𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏.
(𝟓𝟓, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏) and (𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐)
d. List three additional ordered pairs that are solutions to the compound sentence 𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏.
Ask:
How many possible answers are there to part (d)?
Can anyone come up with a non-integer solution?
Discuss that just as they saw with compound equations in one variable, solving pairs of equations in two variables linked
by AND is given by common solution points.
How does the solution set change if the inequality is changed to 𝑥𝑥 + 𝑦𝑦 ≥ 10?
The point (3, 7) would be added to the solution set.
Have students complete (e) and (f) in pairs and discuss responses.
e. Sketch the solution set to the inequality 𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚 > 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and the solution set to
𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏 on the same set of coordinate axes. Highlight the points that lie
in BOTH solution sets.
All points that lie on the line 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏 and above the line 𝒚𝒚 = −𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
Which gives a more clear idea of the solution set: the graph or the verbal description?
Answers could vary. The verbal description is pretty clear, but later in the lesson we will see systems
with solution sets that would be difficult to describe adequately without a graph.
Example 1 (7 minutes)
In Grade 8, students solved systems of linear equations both graphically and algebraically (using both substitution and
elimination techniques), so this should primarily be a review. Work through the example as a class, introducing the
notation shown as indicating a system of equations, wherein the two or more equations given are understood to be
compound statements connected with an “and”. Also convey that the word simultaneous from the title of the lesson is
another way of saying that all equations must be true, simultaneously.
Example 1
𝒙𝒙 − (𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏) = 𝟕𝟕
𝒙𝒙 = −𝟖𝟖
𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐(−𝟖𝟖) + 𝟏𝟏
𝒚𝒚 = −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
Reinforce that even though the “and” is not stated explicitly, it is implied when given a system of equations. Problems
written using this notation are asking one to find the solution(s) where 𝑦𝑦 = 2𝑥𝑥 + 1 and 𝑥𝑥 − 𝑦𝑦 = 17. Work the problem
using substitution. The elimination method is reviewed in the next lesson.
Exercise 1
𝒚𝒚 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 − 𝟏𝟏
𝟏𝟏
𝒚𝒚 = − 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟖𝟖
𝟐𝟐
(𝟐𝟐, 𝟕𝟕)
𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟒𝟒
b. �
𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑𝒚𝒚 = 𝟗𝟗
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟒𝟒
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 = 𝟗𝟗
𝟑𝟑 𝟓𝟓 Scaffolding:
� , �
𝟒𝟒 𝟐𝟐 In Algebra II, students will solve
systems containing three
unknowns. Challenge early
finishers with this problem:
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟓𝟓
c. � If 𝑥𝑥 + 𝑦𝑦 = 1 and 𝑦𝑦 + 𝑧𝑧 = 2
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟖𝟖
and 𝑥𝑥 + 𝑧𝑧 = 3, find 𝑥𝑥, 𝑦𝑦,
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟓𝟓
and 𝑧𝑧.
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟖𝟖
Answer: (1,0,2).
No solution
As students finish, have them put both the graphical and algebraic approaches on the board for parts (a)–(c) or display
student work using a document camera. Discuss as a class.
Were you able to find the exact solution from the graph?
Not for part (b).
Solving by graphing sometimes only yields an approximate solution.
How can you tell when a system of equations will have no solution from the graph?
The graphs do not intersect. For linear systems, this occurs when the lines have the same slope but
have different 𝑦𝑦-intercepts, which means the lines will be parallel.
What if a system of linear equations had the same slope and the same y-intercept?
There would be an infinite number of solutions (all points that lie on the line).
Example 2 (5 minutes)
Example 2
Now suppose the system of equations from Exercise 1(c) was instead a system of inequalities:
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒚𝒚 ≥ 𝟓𝟓
�
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒚𝒚 ≤ 𝟖𝟖
Graph the solution set.
How did the solution set change from Exercise 1(c) to Example 2? What if we changed the problem to 3𝑥𝑥 + 𝑦𝑦 ≤
MP.7 5 and 3𝑥𝑥 + 𝑦𝑦 ≥ 8?
There would be no solution.
The solution to a system of inequalities is where their shaded regions intersect. Let this idea lead into Example 3.
Example 3 (5 minutes)
Instruct students to graph and shade the solution set to each inequality in two different colored pencils. Give them a
few minutes to complete this individually. Then discuss the solution to the system as a class.
Example 3
Exercise 2 (8 minutes)
Have students complete Exercise 2 individually and then compare their answers with a neighbor.
Exercise 2
𝒚𝒚 ≤ 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟒𝟒
b. �𝒚𝒚 ≤ 𝟒𝟒 − 𝒙𝒙
𝒚𝒚 ≥ 𝟎𝟎
Could you express the solution set of a system of inequalities without using a graph?
Yes, using set notation, but a graph makes it easier to visualize and conceptualize which points are in
the solution set.
How can you check your solution graph?
Test a few points to confirm that the points in the shaded region satisfy all the inequalities.
Closing (2 minutes)
What are the different ways to solve a system of equations?
Graphically, algebraically, or numerically (using a table).
Explain the limitations of solving a system of equations graphically.
It is always subject to inaccuracies associated with reading graphs, so we are only able to approximate
an intersection point.
Explain the limitations of expressing the solution to a system of inequalities without using a graph.
It is difficult to describe the solution set without simply restating the problem in set notation, which is
hard to visualize or conceptualize.
Exit Ticket
2. Write the two equations for the system of equations and find the
exact solution to the system algebraically.
2. Write the two equations for the system of equations and find the exact
solution to the system algebraically.
𝒚𝒚 = −𝒙𝒙 + 𝟔𝟔
� 𝟑𝟑
𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑
𝟒𝟒
𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 𝟔𝟔
𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑 = −𝒙𝒙 + 𝟔𝟔 𝒚𝒚 = − + 𝟔𝟔 =
𝟒𝟒 𝟕𝟕 𝟕𝟕
𝟕𝟕
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟗𝟗
𝟒𝟒
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝒙𝒙 =
𝟕𝟕
𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 𝟔𝟔
� , �
𝟕𝟕 𝟕𝟕
1. Solve the following system of equations first by graphing and then algebraically.
𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚 = −𝟓𝟓
�
𝒙𝒙 + 𝟒𝟒𝒚𝒚 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
−𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓
� , �
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
2.
a. Without graphing, construct a system of two linear equations where (𝟎𝟎, 𝟓𝟓) is a solution to the first equation
but is not a solution to the second equation, and (𝟑𝟑, 𝟖𝟖) is a solution to the system.
The first equation must be 𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓; the second equation could be any equation that is different from 𝒚𝒚 =
𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓, and whose graph passes through (𝟑𝟑, 𝟖𝟖); for example, 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟐𝟐 will work.
b. Graph the system and label the graph to show that the system you
created in part (a) satisfies the given conditions.
3. Consider two linear equations. The graph of the first equation is shown. A table of values satisfying the second
equation is given. What is the solution to the system of the two equations?
𝒙𝒙 −𝟒𝟒 −𝟐𝟐 𝟎𝟎 𝟐𝟐 𝟒𝟒
𝒚𝒚 −𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 −𝟐𝟐 𝟔𝟔
𝒙𝒙 ≥ 𝟎𝟎
4. Graph the solution to the following system of inequalities: � 𝒚𝒚 < 𝟐𝟐
𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 > 𝟎𝟎
6. For each question below, provide an explanation or an example to support your claim.
a. Is it possible to have a system of equations that has no solution?
b. Is it possible to have a system of equations that has more than one solution?
Yes, for example, if the equations have the same graph, or in general, if the graphs intersect more than once.
Yes, for example, if the solution sets of individual inequalities, represented by shaded regions on the
coordinate plane, do not overlap.
Student Outcomes
Students create systems of equations that have the same solution set as a given system.
Students understand that adding a multiple of one equation to another creates a new system of two linear
equations with the same solution set as the original system. This property provides a justification for a method
to solve a system of two linear equations algebraically.
Lesson Notes
Students explore standard A.REI.C.5 in great detail. They have already developed proficiency with solving a system of
two linear equations. This lesson delves into why the elimination method works and further enhances student
understanding of equivalence.
Classwork
Opening Exercise (3 minutes)
This should go very quickly. Expect students to substitute 3 for 𝑥𝑥 and 4 for 𝑦𝑦 into both equations. If students struggle
with this piece, you may need to reinforce what it means when an ordered pair is a solution to simultaneous equations
and continue to reinforce that notion throughout the lesson.
Opening Exercise
Here is a system of two linear equations. Verify that the solution to this system is (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒).
Equation A1: 𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏
𝟒𝟒 = 𝟑𝟑 + 𝟏𝟏 is a true equation.
Exploratory Challenge
a. Write down another system of two linear equations whose solution is (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒). This time make sure both linear
equations have a positive slope.
Equation B1: 𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏
y
b. Verify that the solution to this system of two linear 10
equations is (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒).
e. Add A1 and A2 to create a new equation C1. Then, multiply A1 by 𝟑𝟑 to create a new equation C2. Why is the
solution to this system also (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒)? Explain your reasoning.
If you substitute 𝟑𝟑 for 𝒙𝒙 and 𝟒𝟒 for 𝒚𝒚, both equations are true, so (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒) is a solution. When A1 was multiplied
by 𝟑𝟑, it did not create a new equation. Both equations had (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒) as a solution; therefore, when we add the
equations, (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒) will still be a solution because of the addition property of equality.
Hold a class discussion before moving on to parts (f)–(i). When you debrief and discuss, be sure to highlight the different
approaches. Begin to distinguish between solutions where students created a new system by simply multiplying one
equation or both by a constant factor and those who create two new equations that both contain the point (3, 4).
What different approaches did groups use to solve this problem?
I used guess and check.
I started with the point (3, 4) and realized I could pick any slope I wanted. I moved left 3 and down 4
4
until I got to the (0, 0); therefore, my equation would be 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑥𝑥.
3
When you multiplied one equation by a constant, did it actually create a different linear equation? When you
added two equations together, did it actually create a different equation?
Multiplying by a constant doesn’t create a different equation because the slope and 𝑦𝑦-intercept are the
same. Adding two equations together does create a new equation because the slope is different.
Move on to parts (f)–(i). These questions specifically direct students to consider creating a new system by multiplying
one equation by a constant and adding it to another. Students are considering whether or not this is a valid way to
generate a system with the same solution. Have each group record their answer to part (i) on the board to show that
this method works regardless of the number by which you multiply.
The following system of equations was obtained from the original system by adding a multiple of equation A2 to equation
A1.
Equation D1: 𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏
g. What is the solution to the system of two linear equations formed by D1 and D2?
The solution is still (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒). I checked by substituting (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒) into both equations.
No, the slope of D2 is −𝟏𝟏. Neither of the original equations had that slope.
i. Start with equation A1. Multiply it by a number of your choice and add the result to equation A2. This
creates a new equation E2. Record E2 below to check if the solution is (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒).
Equation E1: 𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏
I multiplied A1 by 𝟒𝟒 to get 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝟒𝟒. Adding it to A2 gives 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. We already know (𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒) is a
solution to 𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏. Substituting into E2 gives 𝟓𝟓(𝟒𝟒) = 𝟐𝟐(𝟑𝟑) + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, which is a true equation. Therefore,
(𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒) is a solution to this new system.
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟔𝟔
𝒙𝒙 − 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 = −𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
Multiply the first equation by 𝟑𝟑 and add it to the second. Solve the new system. (𝟏𝟏, 𝟒𝟒)
Exercises 1–2
Explain a way to create a new system of equations with the same solution as the original that eliminates variable 𝒚𝒚
from one equation. Then determine the solution.
ORIGINAL SYSTEM NEW SYSTEM SOLUTION
𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 + 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 = 𝟕𝟕
𝒙𝒙 − 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟏𝟏
Multiply the second equation by 𝟑𝟑, and add it to the first one.
ORIGINAL SYSTEM NEW SYSTEM SOLUTION
Explain a way to create a new system of equations with the same solution as the original that eliminates variable 𝒙𝒙
from one equation. Then determine the solution.
𝟐𝟐𝒙𝒙 + 𝟑𝟑𝒚𝒚 = 𝟕𝟕
𝒙𝒙 − 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟏𝟏
Multiply the second equation by −𝟐𝟐, and add it to the first one.
Closing (2 minutes)
Close with a reminder that this lesson was about proving that a technique to solve a system of equations is valid.
There are many ways to generate systems of equations that have the same solution set, but the technique
explored in Exercises 1 and 2 is especially helpful if you are trying to solve a system algebraically.
Exit Ticket
The sum of two numbers is 10 and the difference is 6. What are the numbers?
3. Create a new system of two linear equations using the methods described in part (i) of the Exploratory Challenge.
Verify that the new system has the same solution.
The sum of two numbers is 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and the difference is 𝟔𝟔. What are the numbers?
𝒙𝒙 + 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 and 𝒙𝒙 − 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟔𝟔
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟖𝟖 and 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐
Create a new system of two linear equations using the methods described in part (i) of the Exploratory Challenge.
Verify that the new system has the same solution.
Answers in parts (a) and (b) are obtained by adding and subtracting the two original equations WITHOUT actually
solving for 𝒙𝒙 and 𝒚𝒚 first.
You always get the same solution no matter which two of the four equations you choose from Problem 1 to form a
system of two linear equations. Explain why this is true.
The reason is that the 3rd equation is the difference of the 1st and the 2nd; the 4th equation is the sum of the 1st and
the 2nd. When we add (or subtract) two equations to create a new equation, no new (or independent) information is
created. The 3rd and 4th equations are thus not independent of the 1st and the 2nd. They still contain the solution
common to their parent equations, the 1st and 2nd.
𝟏𝟏
𝒚𝒚 = 𝒙𝒙
Solve the system of equations � 𝟒𝟒 by graphing. Then, create a new system of equations that has the same
𝒚𝒚 = −𝒙𝒙 + 𝟓𝟓
solution. Show either algebraically or graphically that the systems have the same solution.
Without solving the systems, explain why the following systems must have the same solution.
System (i): 𝟒𝟒𝒙𝒙 − 𝟓𝟓𝒚𝒚 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 System (ii): 𝟖𝟖𝒙𝒙 − 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐
Solve each system of equations by writing a new system that eliminates one of the variables.
𝒚𝒚 = −𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 𝒚𝒚 = −𝟏𝟏
Student Outcomes
Students use systems of equations or inequalities to solve contextual problems and interpret solutions within a
particular context.
Lesson Notes
This lesson introduces students to the idea of using systems to solve various application problems in order to prepare
them for more extensive modeling tasks that they encounter in Topic D.
Classwork
Opening Exercise (8 minutes)
Have students brainstorm this problem in groups. Allow groups to share different approaches to solving the problem
MP.3 (i.e., guess and check, making a table, or algebraically). Encourage students to critique the various approaches.
What were the advantages or disadvantages to the various approaches? Lead students through the algebraic approach.
Then, discuss the following:
Opening Exercise
In Lewis Carroll’s Through the Looking Glass, Tweedledum says, “The sum of your weight and twice mine is 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 pounds.”
Tweedledee replies, “The sum of your weight and twice mine is 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 pounds.” Find both of their weights.
Let 𝒙𝒙 = the number of pounds Tweedledee weighs, and let 𝒚𝒚 = the number of pounds Tweedledum weighs.
𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
𝒚𝒚 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑
Tweedledum weighs 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 pounds, and Tweedledee weighs 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 pounds.
Discussion (5 minutes)
Could we solve the problem above using only Tweedledum’s sentence?
No. There are two unknowns, and as we saw in earlier lessons, the equation 𝑥𝑥 + 2𝑦𝑦 = 361 has an
infinite number of solutions.
In a situation where there are two unknowns, how many equations do we need to write in order to solve the
system?
Two equations.
If I told you I was holding 20 coins that were some mix of dimes and quarters, could you tell me anything about
how many of each I have?
You could only list possible combinations (1 dime and 19 quarters, 2 dimes and 18 quarters, etc.).
What other piece of information would be useful in determining how many of each type of coin I was holding?
The total amount of money, how many more or fewer quarters than dimes, etc.
Example 1 (5 minutes)
Let the discussion lead into Example 1. Work through the example as a class. Make sure students specify the variables
being used in the equations. Discuss the various ways of solving (i.e., graphically, making a table, algebraically). In the
previous lesson, we did not solve systems by making a table. Demonstrate how this might be a useful technique in the
following situation.
Example 1
Lulu tells her little brother, Jack, that she is holding 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 coins all of which are dimes and quarters. They have a value of
$𝟒𝟒. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. She says she will give him the coins if he can tell her how many of each she is holding. Solve this problem for
Jack.
Exploratory Challenge
a. At a state fair, there is a game where you throw a ball at a pyramid of cans. If you knock over all of the cans,
you win a prize. The cost is 𝟑𝟑 throws for $𝟏𝟏, but if have you an armband, you get 6 throws for $𝟏𝟏. The
armband costs $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
i. Write two cost equations for the game in terms of the number of throws purchased, one without an
armband and one with.
Let 𝒙𝒙 = number of throws, and let 𝑪𝑪 = cost.
𝟏𝟏
Without armband: 𝑪𝑪 = 𝒙𝒙
𝟑𝟑
𝟏𝟏
With armband: 𝑪𝑪 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟔𝟔
ii. Graph the two cost equations on the same graph. Be sure to label the axes and show an appropriate
scale.
Point out the constraints of 𝑥𝑥. Without the armband, 𝑥𝑥 must be a multiple of 3; with the armband, 𝑥𝑥 must be a multiple
of 6.
Remind students about discrete and continuous graphs. The graphs of each equation should actually be discrete rather
than continuous. Discuss why other points on the graph would not make sense for this scenario.
b. A clothing manufacturer has 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 yd. of cotton to make shirts and pajamas. A shirt requires 𝟏𝟏 yd. of fabric,
and a pair of pajamas requires 𝟐𝟐 yd. of fabric. It takes 𝟐𝟐 hr. to make a shirt and 𝟑𝟑 hr. to make the pajamas,
and there are 𝟏𝟏, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 hr. available to make the clothing.
i. What are the variables?
The various combinations of shirts and pajamas that it would be possible for the manufacturer to make.
vi. Suppose the manufacturer makes a profit of $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 on shirts and $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 on pajamas. How would it decide
how many of each to make?
The manufacturer wants to make as many as possible, so the maximum should be at one of the
endpoints of the shaded region.
vii. How many of each should the manufacturer make, assuming he will sell all the shirts and pajamas he
makes?
Why does this scenario call for inequalities rather than equations?
He cannot exceed the amount of time or material available but does not necessarily have to use all of it.
The shaded region in a problem of this type is sometimes called the feasible region. Why does this name make
sense?
This is the region that represents the number of shirts and pajamas that he can feasibly make given the
constraints.
Students should intuitively believe that the maximum profit should be at one of the endpoints of the shaded region
(which is true because he is maximizing the given resources). However, you can have students test other points to prove
that intersection point is, in fact, the maximum.
Closing (3 minutes)
Recap the steps followed in solving these problems. Do not have students copy the steps, just discuss the strategy, both
specifically for this problem and then making generic descriptions (e.g., identified the variables, created equations or
inequalities based on the constraints of the problem, decided on the best method for solving, interpreted the solution).
Exit Ticket
Andy’s Cab Service charges a $6 fee plus $0.50 per mile. His twin brother Randy starts a rival business where he charges
$0.80 per mile but does not charge a fee.
1. Write a cost equation for each cab service in terms of the number of miles.
Andy’s Cab Service charges a $𝟔𝟔 fee plus $𝟎𝟎. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 per mile. His twin brother Randy starts a rival business where he
charges $𝟎𝟎. 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 per mile but does not charge a fee.
1. Write a cost equation for each cab service in terms of the number of miles.
See graph.
3. For what trip distances should a customer use Andy’s Cab Service?
For what trip distances should a customer use Randy’s Cab Service?
Justify your answer algebraically, and show the location of the
solution on the graph.
1. Find two numbers such that the sum of the first and three times the second is 𝟓𝟓 and the sum of second and two
times the first is 𝟖𝟖.
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐
The two numbers are and .
𝟓𝟓 𝟓𝟓
2. A chemist has two solutions: a 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓% methane solution and an 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖% methane solution. He wants 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 ml of a 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕%
methane solution. How many ml of each solution does he need to mix?
𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐
The chemist should use 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 mL of the 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓% solution and 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 mL of the 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖% solution.
𝟑𝟑 𝟑𝟑
3. Pam has two part time jobs. At one job, she works as a cashier and makes $𝟖𝟖 per hour. At the second job, she
works as a tutor and makes $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 per hour. One week she worked 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 hours and made $𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. How many hours did
she spend at each job?
She worked at the cashier job for 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 hours and tutored for 𝟕𝟕 hours.
4. A store sells Brazilian coffee for $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 per lb. and Columbian coffee for $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 per lb. If the store decides to make a
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏-lb. blend of the two and sell it for $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 per lb., how much of each type of coffee should be used?
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
They should use 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 lb. of Brazilian coffee and 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 lb. of Columbian coffee.
𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
𝟑𝟑
5. A potter is making cups and plates. It takes her 𝟔𝟔 min. to make a cup and 𝟑𝟑 min. to make a plate. Each cup uses
𝟒𝟒
lb. of clay, and each plate uses 𝟏𝟏 lb. of clay. She has 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 hr. available to make the cups and plates and has 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 lb. of
clay.
a. What are the variables?
𝒄𝒄 = # of cups made
𝒑𝒑 = # of plates made
d. If she makes a profit of $𝟐𝟐 on each cup and $𝟏𝟏. 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 on each plate, how many of each should she make in order
to maximize her profit?
$𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
Mathematics Curriculum
ALGEBRA I • MODULE 1
Topic D:
Creating Equations to Solve Problems
N-Q.A.1, A-SSE.A.1, A-CED.A.1, A-CED.A.2, A-REI.B.3
Focus Standard: N-Q.A.1 Use units as a way to understand problems and to guide the solution of multi-
step problems; choose and interpret units consistently in formulas; choose and
interpret the scale and the origin in graphs and data displays.
A-SSE.A.1 Interpret expressions that represent a quantity in terms of its context. ★
A-SSE.A.1a Interpret parts of an expression, such as terms, factors, and coefficients.
A-SSE.A.1b Interpret complicated expressions by viewing one or more of their parts as a
single entity. For example, interpret P(1+r)n as the product of P and a factor
not depending on P.
A-CED.A.1 Create equations and inequalities in one variable and use them to solve
problems. Include equations arising from linear and quadratic functions, and
simple rational and exponential functions.
A-CED.A.2 Create equations in two or more variables to represent relationships between
quantities; graph equations on coordinate axes with labels and scales.
A-REI.B.3 Solve linear equations and inequalities in one variable, including equations
with coefficients represented by letters.
Instructional Days: 4
Lesson 25: Solving Problems in Two Ways—Rules and Algebra (M)1
Lessons 26–27: Recursive Challenge Problem—The Double and Add 5 Game (M, M)
Lesson 28: Federal Income Tax (M)
In this topic, students are introduced to the modeling cycle (see page 61 of the Common Core Learning
Standards) through problems that can be solved using equations and inequalities in one variable, systems of
equations, and graphing. From the CCLS (page 61):
1 Lesson Structure Key: P-Problem Set Lesson, M-Modeling Cycle Lesson, E-Exploration Lesson, S-Socratic Lesson
Modeling links classroom mathematics and statistics to everyday life, work, and decision-making.
The basic modeling cycle is summarized in the diagram. It involves (1) identifying variables in the
situation and selecting those that represent essential features; (2) formulating a model by creating
and selecting geometric, graphical, tabular, algebraic, or statistical representations that describe
relationships between the variables; (3) analyzing and performing operations on these relationships
to draw conclusions; (4) interpreting the results of the mathematics in terms of the original situation;
(5) validating the conclusions by comparing them with the situation and then either improving the
model; (6) or if it is acceptable, reporting on the conclusions and the reasoning behind them.
Choices, assumptions, and approximations are present throughout this cycle.
The first lesson introduces parts of the modeling cycle using problems and situations that students have
encountered before: creating linear equations, tape diagrams, rates, systems of linear equations, graphs of
systems, etc.
The next lesson, The Double and Add 5 Game, employs the modeling cycle in a mathematical context. In this
2-day lesson, students formulate a model and build an equation to represent the model (in this case,
converting a sequence defined recursively to an explicit formula). After they play the game in a specific case,
“double and add 5,” they have to interpret the results of the mathematics in terms of the original model and
validate whether their model is acceptable. Then they use the model to analyze and report on a problem that
is too difficult to do “by hand” without the model.
Finally, Lesson 28 serves as a signature lesson on modeling as students take on the very real-life example of
understanding federal marginal income tax rates (i.e., the progressive income tax brackets). Students are
provided the current standard deduction tables per dependent or marital status and the marginal income tax
table per marital filing status. For a specific household situation (e.g., married filing jointly with two
dependents), students determine equations for the total Federal Income Tax for different income intervals,
graph the piecewise-defined equations, and answer specific questions about the total effective rate for
different income levels. All elements of the modeling cycle occur as students analyze the information to find,
for example, roughly how much their favorite famous performer paid in federal taxes last year
Student Outcomes
Students investigate a problem that can be solved by reasoning quantitatively and by creating equations in one
variable.
Students compare the numerical approach to the algebraic approach.
Classwork
Exercise 1 (10 minutes)
Exercise 1
𝟏𝟏
a. Solve the following problem first using a tape diagram and then using an equation: In a school choir, of the
𝟐𝟐
members were girls. At the end of the year, 𝟑𝟑 boys left the choir, and the ratio of boys to girls became 3:4.
How many boys remained in the choir?
b. Which problem solution, the one using a tape diagram or the one using an equation, was easier to set up and
solve? Why?
Answers will vary. Most should say the tape diagram since it requires significantly less work than solving the
problem algebraically. Point out that this may not always be the case.
Modify the question so that the tape diagram solution would definitely not be the easier way to solve the
problem.
6
Sample question: In a school choir, of the members were girls. At the end of the year, 3 boys had left the
11
choir, and the ratio of the number of boys to the number of girls was 3: 4. How many boys remained in the
choir?
Exercise 2
All the printing presses at a print shop were scheduled to make copies of a novel and a cookbook. They were to print the
same number of copies of each book, but the novel had twice as many pages as the cookbook. All of the printing presses
worked for the first day on the larger book, turning out novels. Then, on day two, the presses were split into two equally
sized groups. The first group continued printing copies of the novel and finished printing all the copies by the evening of
the second day. The second group worked on the cookbook but did not finish by evening. One printing press, working for
two additional full days, finished printing the remaining copies of the cookbooks. If all printing presses printed pages (for
both the novel and cookbook) at the same constant rate, how many printing presses are there at the print shop?
Analyze the problem with your students, rereading the problem together as you answer questions like:
What is this story about?
Printing novels and cookbooks
Will more novels be printed than cookbooks or less?
Neither. The same number of each will be printed.
How many pages does the novel have compared to the cookbook?
Twice as many as the cookbook
How much longer would one printing press take to print a novel versus a cookbook?
Twice as long
Is it important to know how many pages each book has or how many of each book will need to be printed?
Why?
No. Answers will vary.
How many of the printing presses are used to print the novel on the first day?
All of them.
How many of the printing presses are used to print the novel on the second day?
One half of them.
How many of the printing presses are used to print the cookbook on the second day?
One half of them.
How many printing presses are used to print the remainder of the cookbooks on the third and fourth days?
One.
How many printing presses could be used to print the remainder of the cookbooks in one day instead of two?
Two printing presses could have finished the cookbooks on the third day.
What are we trying to find in this problem?
The number of printing presses at the print shop.
a. Solve the problem working with rates to setup a tape diagram or an area model.
One of the keys to a (somewhat) simple solution using an area model is recognizing that the novel has twice as many
pages as the cookbook, so the area that represents the novel job should be twice the size as the area used to represent
the cookbook job.
Draw a rectangular region to represent the work needed to complete the novel job and another rectangular region, half
the size, to represent the work needed to complete the cookbook job.
On the first day, all the printing presses were used on printing copies of the novel, and on the second day, half
completed the novel while half worked on the cookbook.
1
Students can test conjectures on why the novel job is split into thirds. For example, if all printing presses completed of
2
1 1 3
the novel job on day 1, then of the printing presses would only complete of the job on day 2. Therefore, only of the
2 4 4
novel job would be complete by the end of day two. But the story says the whole novel job is complete by the end of
day two (i.e., something is wrong with that conjecture).
Once students understand that the novel job must be split into thirds, label the novel job, the “whole unit,” and each
1 1 1
third unit as the fractional unit, “ of the whole.” The cookbook job is then “ of the whole.” The same unit must have
3 2 3
1 1 1
also been completed on the cookbook job on day 2, leaving − = of the whole unit left for days 3 and 4.
2 3 6
Each of the small rectangles in the picture above represents how much
of the whole job (i.e., novel job) one printing press can do in one day.
Drawing in the small rectangle units into the rest of the diagram, one
sees that eight printing presses worked on the novel job on day 1, which
was all of the printing presses. Hence, there are eight printing presses at
the print shop! Students now know there are eight printing presses at
the workshop. This should help them confirm their solution paths in
Exercise 2(b)!
Start by asking students to write down all variables for the quantities they see in the problem, giving an appropriate
letter for each. While it does not matter if they work with the number of copies of cookbooks or the number of pages
MP.2
per cookbook, guide them to use the number of copies of cookbooks as you walk around your class. (Tell students not to
worry about writing down too many letters—there is no need to write all of them.)
Be careful not to write on the board, printing presses = 𝑥𝑥. Such a statement abuses how the = symbol should be used.
Such statements do not make sense—printing presses aren’t numbers! It is a good idea to require students to develop
the habit of always properly labeling their variables using short descriptions (e.g., number of printing presses: 𝑥𝑥). This
habit can help them significantly in setting up equations and solving algebra problems.
Next, ask students to write down important expressions using the variables above. There are many valid possible
expressions they can write down that can be used to solve the problem. Here is one possible list:
Novels:
𝟏𝟏
Number of copies of novels printed in one day by the entire print shop: 𝒓𝒓𝒓𝒓.
𝟐𝟐
𝟏𝟏
Number of copies of novels printed in one day by half of the entire print shop: 𝒓𝒓𝒓𝒓.
𝟒𝟒
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟑𝟑
Total number of copies of novels printed: 𝒓𝒓𝒓𝒓 + 𝒓𝒓𝒓𝒓, or 𝒓𝒓𝒓𝒓.
𝟐𝟐 𝟒𝟒 𝟒𝟒
Cookbooks:
𝟏𝟏
Number of copies of cookbooks printed in one day by half of the entire print shop: 𝒓𝒓𝒓𝒓.
𝟐𝟐
Number of copies of cookbooks printed in two days by one printing press: 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐.
𝟏𝟏
Total number of copies of cookbooks printed: 𝒓𝒓𝒓𝒓 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐.
𝟐𝟐
Since the number of cookbooks and novels is the same, we can equate the expressions of the totals above to get:
3 1
𝑟𝑟𝑟𝑟 = 𝑟𝑟𝑟𝑟 + 2𝑟𝑟.
4 2
Since 𝑟𝑟 is known not to be zero, we can divide both sides of the equation by 𝑟𝑟, and solve the resulting equation for 𝑥𝑥:
𝟑𝟑 𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐
𝟒𝟒 𝟐𝟐
𝟑𝟑 𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 − 𝒙𝒙 = 𝒙𝒙 + 𝟐𝟐 − 𝒙𝒙
𝟒𝟒 𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐
𝟏𝟏
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐
𝟒𝟒
𝟏𝟏
𝟒𝟒 � 𝒙𝒙� = 𝟒𝟒(𝟐𝟐)
𝟒𝟒
𝒙𝒙 = 𝟖𝟖
𝟑𝟑
Check by substituting 𝟖𝟖 back into the original equation. The left hand side is 𝒓𝒓(𝟖𝟖) = 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, which is equal to the right
𝟒𝟒
𝟏𝟏
hand side, 𝒓𝒓(𝟖𝟖) + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 + 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 = 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔.
𝟐𝟐
There are 𝟖𝟖 printing presses in the print shop!
Because there are a number of ways to setup a correct equation, students will inevitably create several solution paths. If
MP.1 time permits, explore the different solution paths with students. Help them see that their solution is just as valid as the
teacher’s.
Closing (3 minutes)
Pose the following questions to your students:
How can you tell that this problem was not about a real situation? That is, how can you tell it was completely
made up?
The clue that this is a made up problem is the following question: Why would the number of printing
presses not be known in this situation?
In a real-life situation, not only would the number of printing presses be known, but the constant speed in
which they print pages would be known, too. Plus, knowing the page quantity for each book would certainly
be a factor in scheduling the job, as well as knowing exactly how many books each client wanted in total.
The problem was made up to ask the following Exit Ticket question.
Exit Ticket
Suppose we know that the print shop had 8 printing presses and each printing press runs at a constant speed of 5,000
pages per hour for 6 hours a day.
1. Compute the total number of pages printed for the cookbook job, and the total number of pages printed for the
novel job following the schedule and situation described in Exercise 2.
2. Describe a scenario where it would make sense for the job scheduler to schedule both jobs as described in Exercise
2.
BONUS
3. If the novel was 500 pages and the cookbook 250 pages, how many copies of each were printed?
Suppose we know that the print shop had 𝟖𝟖 printing presses, and each printing press runs at a constant speed of 𝟓𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎
pages per hour for 𝟔𝟔 hours a day.
1. Compute the total number of pages printed for the cookbook job and the total number of pages printed for the
novel job following the schedule and situation described in Exercise 2(a).
Ratio of number of pages of the novel to the number of pages of the cookbook: 𝟐𝟐: 𝟏𝟏.
Therefore, 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 pages for the novel and 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 for the cookbook.
2. Describe a scenario where it would make sense for the job scheduler to schedule both jobs as described in Exercise
2(a).
The client for the novel job wants the print job completed by midweek, whereas the cookbook does not need to be
completed until the end of the week.
3. BONUS: if the novel was 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 pages and the cookbook 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 pages, how many copies of each were printed?
1. Solve the following problems first using a tape diagram and then by setting up an equation. For each, give your
opinion on which solution method was easier. Can you see the connection(s) between the two methods? What
does each “unit” in the tape diagram stand for?
a. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 years from now, Pia’s age will be twice her age 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 years ago. Find her present age.
Tape:
Equation:
b. The total age of a woman and her son is 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 years. Three years ago, the woman was eight times as old as her
son. How old is her son now?
Tape:
Equation:
c. Five years from now, the sum of the ages of a woman and her daughter will be 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 years. The difference in
their present age is 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 years. How old is her daughter now?
Tape:
Equation:
Equation:
b. Find two consecutive even numbers such that the sum of the smaller number and twice the greater number is
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
c. If 𝟗𝟗 is subtracted from a number, and the result is multiplied by 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, the product is 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. Find the number.
d. The product of two consecutive whole numbers is less than the sum of the square of the smaller number and
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
Rework this problem: Write an equation using 𝑳𝑳 as the length (in meters) of the rectangle that would lead to the
solution of the problem. Check that the answer above is correct by substituting 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 for 𝑳𝑳 in your equation.
4. Jim tells you he paid a total of $𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎. 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 for a car, and you would like to know the price of the car before sales
tax so that you can compare the price of that model of car at various dealers. Find price of the car before sales tax if
Jim bought the car in each of the following states:
a. Arizona, where the sales tax is 𝟔𝟔. 𝟔𝟔%.
Solving 𝒙𝒙(𝟏𝟏 + 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎) = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 results in 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔. The car costs $𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔.
Solving 𝒙𝒙(𝟏𝟏 + 𝟎𝟎. 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎) = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 results in 𝒙𝒙 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑. The car costs $𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑.
5. A checking account is set up with an initial balance of $𝟗𝟗, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒, and $𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 is removed from the account at the end of
each month for rent (no other user transactions occur on the account).
a. Write an inequality whose solutions are the months, 𝒎𝒎, in which the account balance is greater than $𝟑𝟑, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎.
Write the solution set to your equation by identifying all of the solutions.
For 𝒎𝒎 a non-negative real number, m satisfies the inequality, 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 − 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 > 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑. For real numbers 𝒎𝒎,
the solution set is 𝟎𝟎 ≤ 𝒎𝒎 < 𝟖𝟖.
b. Make a graph of the balance in the account after 𝒎𝒎 months and indicate on the plot the solutions to your
inequality in part (a).
Students can create a step-function (like below), or simply plot the points (with no lines drawn). Drawing a
straight line through the points, however, does not accurately reflect the information in the problem.
6. Axel and his brother like to play tennis. About three months ago they decided to keep track of how many games
they have each won. As of today, Axel has won 𝟏𝟏𝟖𝟖 out of the 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 games against his brother.
a. How many games would Axel have to win in a row in order to have a 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕% winning record?
Solving 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒏𝒏 = 𝟎𝟎. 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕(𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒏𝒏) results in 𝒏𝒏 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. He would have to win 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 games.
b. How many games would Axel have to win in a row in order to have a 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗% winning record?
Solving 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒏𝒏 = 𝟎𝟎. 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗(𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒏𝒏) results in 𝒏𝒏 = 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗. He would have to win 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 games.
c. Is Axel ever able to reach a 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏% winning record? Explain why or why not.
No. A 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏% winning record would mean solving the equation 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒏𝒏 = 𝟏𝟏(𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 + 𝒏𝒏), which has no solutions.
d. Suppose that after reaching a winning record of 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗% in part (b), Axel had a losing streak. How many games
in a row would Axel have to lose in order to drop down to a winning record of 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔% again?
Solving, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟎𝟎. 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔(𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 + 𝒏𝒏), results in 𝒏𝒏 = 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔. He would have to lose 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 games.
7. Omar has $𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖 and Calina has $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. How much money must Omar give to Calina so that Calina will have three times
as much as Omar?
a. Solve the problem above by setting up an equation.
Solution 1:
Solve:
Check: Omar now has $𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 and Calina has $𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕, which is three times as much as Omar.
Solution 2:
A few students might notice that if Calina has three times as much as Omar afterwards, and if we let 𝒚𝒚 be the
amount that Omar has after, then 𝒚𝒚 + 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 = 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗, or 𝒚𝒚 = 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐. Now it is easy to find out how much Omar gave.
b. In your opinion, is this problem easier to solve using an equation or using a tape diagram? Why?
Most likely, students will say it is easier to solve with an equation because it is easier to set up and solve.
(They may show an attempt at drawing a tape diagram, for example.) However, students who used the
second solution may respond that the tape diagram is easier.
Student Outcomes
Students learn the meaning and notation of recursive sequences in a modeling setting.
Following the modeling cycle, students investigate the double and add 5 game in a simple case in order to
understand the statement of the main problem.
Lesson Notes
The double and add 5 game is loosely related to the Collatz conjecture—an unsolved conjecture in mathematics named
after Lothar Collatz, who first proposed the problem in 1937. The conjecture includes a recurrence relation, triple and
add 1, as part of the problem statement. A worthwhile activity for you and your class is to read about the conjecture
online.
Students begin by playing the Double and Add 5 game in a simple situation. Given a number, double it and add 5. The
result of round 2 is the double of the result of Round 1 plus 5, and so on. The goal of the game is to find the smallest
starting whole number, 𝑎𝑎0 , that produces a number 100 or greater in three rounds or fewer (Answer: 𝑎𝑎0 = 9). Students
are then exposed to the more difficult challenge of finding the smallest starting whole number that produces a number
1,000 or greater in three rounds or fewer. To solve this problem, the notation of recursive sequences and recursive
relations are explained, and students formalize the problem in terms of an equation, solve, interpret their answer, and
validate (answer: 𝑎𝑎0 = 121).
Classwork
This challenging two-day modeling lesson (see page 61 of CCLS) about recursive sequences runs through the problem,
formulate, compute, interpret, validate, report modeling cycle. This modeling activity involves playing a game and
MP.4
describing the mathematical process in the game using a recurrence relation in order to solve a harder version of the
game. Please read through both lessons before planning out your class time.
Example 1 (7 minutes)
This activity describes the process so students can be given the problem statement. Introduce it by stating that you
want to create an interesting sequence by doubling and adding 5.
Work through the table below with your students on the board to explain the meaning of the following:
• starting number,
• double and add 5,
• result of round one,
• result of round two, and so on.
Here is what the table looks like at the beginning:
Number Double and add 5
starting number 1 1∙2+5= 7 result of round 1
7 7 ∙ 2 + 5 = 19 result of round 2
Example 1
Exercise 1 (5 minutes)
Have students complete the tables in Exercise 1. Walk around the classroom to ensure they are completing the tables
correctly and understand the process.
Exercise 1
Exercise 2
Given a starting number, double it and add 𝟓𝟓 to get the result of Round 1. Double the result of Round 1 and add 𝟓𝟓, and so
on. The goal of the game is to find the smallest starting whole number that produces a result of 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 or greater in three
rounds or fewer.
Walk around the class, observe student work, and give advice, such as:
Does starting with 10 produce a result of 100 or greater in Round 3?
Yes.
Why will all numbers greater than 10 work? Can you find a smaller starting number that also works?
Do you see any patterns in the tables you have already created?
As the starting number increases by 1, the result of Round 3 increases by 8.
Yes, 9 works. Is it the smallest?
Yes. When I start with 8, I need four rounds to get past 100.
After 8 minutes, show (or have a student show) that 9 is the correct answer by showing the tables:
Invite students to share other methods for finding the answer. For example, some may have worked the problem
100−5 47.5−5
backwards: If 100 is reached in three rounds, then = 47.5 must have been reached in two rounds, and =
MP.1 2
21.25−5
2
21.25 must been reached after the first round, which means the starting number is greater than = 8.125, or the
2
whole number 9.
Tell students that the next goal is to solve the same problem, but find the smallest number that results in 1,000 in three
rounds or fewer:
Given a starting number, double it and add 5 to get the result of Round 1. Double the result of Round 1 and add
5, and so on. The goal of the game is to find the smallest starting whole number that produces a result of 1,000
or greater in three rounds or fewer.
This problem is not as easy as the starter problem to solve by guess-and-check. To solve this problem, guide students to
formulate an equation. But first, you will need to explain how mathematicians create and describe recursive sequences.
Let 𝑎𝑎1 be the number of the result of Round 1. We can also label the result of Round 2 as 𝑎𝑎2 , and so on. Ask, “How
could we label the starting number?” Guide them to label the starting number as 𝑎𝑎0 . Then write an equation in terms of
𝑎𝑎0 and 𝑎𝑎1 in the table (that is still on the board) like this:
Ask students to help you complete and extend the table as follows:
Highlight on the board that the ordered list of terms 5, 15, 35, 75,… can be described by an initial value, 𝑎𝑎0 = 5, and a
recurrence relation, 𝑎𝑎𝑖𝑖+1 = 2𝑎𝑎𝑖𝑖 + 5, for 𝑖𝑖 ≥ 0. Written as follows:
𝑎𝑎0 = 5
�
𝑎𝑎𝑖𝑖+1 = 2𝑎𝑎𝑖𝑖 + 5, 𝑖𝑖 ≥ 0
Tell them that this is an example of a recursively-defined sequence, or simply, a recursive sequence.
Have students mentally use the recurrence relation to find the next term after 75. Is it the double and add
5 rule?
Ask:
What other terms have we studied so far that are defined recursively?
Algebraic expressions, polynomial expressions, monomials
Teacher note: Terms that are defined recursively often use the term itself in the statement of the definition, but the
definition of the term is not considered circular. Circularity does not arise in recursively defined terms because they
always start with a well-defined set of base examples, and then the definition describes how to generate new examples
of the term from those base examples, which, by reiterating further, can then be used to generate all other examples of
the term. The base examples prevent the definition from being circular. For recursive sequences, the base example(s) is
just the initial value(s). For algebraic expressions, the well-defined base examples are numerical symbols and variable
symbols.
Exercise 3
Using a generic initial value,𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 , and the recurrence relation, 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝟐𝟐𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊 + 𝟓𝟓, for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟎𝟎, find a formula for 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 , 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐, 𝒂𝒂𝟑𝟑, 𝒂𝒂𝟒𝟒
in terms of 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 .
Let students work individually or in pairs. Visit each group and ask questions that lead students to the following:
Closing (5 minutes)
Discuss the following definitions in the student materials:
Vocabulary
Sequence: A sequence can be thought of as an ordered list of elements. The elements of the list are called the terms of
the sequence.
For example, (P, O, O, L) is a sequence that is different than (L, O, O, P). Usually the terms are indexed (and therefore
ordered) by a subscript starting at either 𝟎𝟎 or 𝟏𝟏: 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 , 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐, 𝒂𝒂𝟑𝟑 , 𝒂𝒂𝟒𝟒 , …. The “…” symbol indicates that the pattern described
is regular, that is, the next term is 𝒂𝒂𝟓𝟓 , and the next is 𝒂𝒂𝟔𝟔 , and so on. In the first example, 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 = 𝑷𝑷 is the first term, 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 =
𝑶𝑶 is the second term, and so on. Both finite and infinite sequences exist everywhere in mathematics. For example, the
𝟏𝟏
infinite decimal expansion of = 𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 … can be represented as the sequence, (𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑, 𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑, 𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑, 𝟎𝟎. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑, …).
𝟑𝟑
Recursive Sequence: An example of a recursive sequence is a sequence that is defined by (1) specifying the values of one
or more initial terms and (2) having the property that the remaining terms satisfy a recurrence relation that describes the
value of a term based upon an algebraic expression in numbers, previous terms, or the index of the term.
The sequence generated by initial term, 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 = 𝟑𝟑, and recurrence relation, 𝒂𝒂𝒏𝒏 = 𝟑𝟑𝒂𝒂𝒏𝒏−𝟏𝟏 , is the sequence
(𝟑𝟑, 𝟗𝟗, 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟖𝟖𝟖𝟖, 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, …). Another example, given by the initial terms, 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 = 𝟏𝟏, 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 = 𝟏𝟏, and recurrence relation, 𝒂𝒂𝒏𝒏 =
𝒂𝒂𝒏𝒏−𝟏𝟏 + 𝒂𝒂𝒏𝒏−𝟐𝟐 , generates the famed Fibonacci sequence (𝟏𝟏, 𝟏𝟏, 𝟐𝟐, 𝟑𝟑, 𝟓𝟓, …).
Exit Ticket
The following sequence was generated by an initial value 𝑎𝑎0 and recurrence relation 𝑎𝑎𝑖𝑖+1 = 2𝑎𝑎𝑖𝑖 + 5, for 𝑖𝑖 ≥ 0.
The following sequence was generated by an initial value 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 and recurrence relation 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝟐𝟐𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊 + 𝟓𝟓, for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟎𝟎.
1. Write down the first 𝟓𝟓 terms of the recursive sequences defined by the initial values and recurrence relations below:
a. 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 = 𝟎𝟎 and 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊 + 𝟏𝟏, for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟎𝟎,
(𝟎𝟎, 𝟏𝟏, 𝟐𝟐, 𝟑𝟑, 𝟒𝟒)
𝟏𝟏
i. 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 = 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 and 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = �− � 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊, for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟏𝟏,
𝟐𝟐
(𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, −𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, −𝟖𝟖, 𝟒𝟒)
2. Look at the sequences you created in Problems 1(b) through 1(d). How would you define a recursive sequence that
generates multiples of 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑?
3. Look at the sequences you created in problems 1(e) through 1(g). How would you define a recursive sequence that
generates powers of 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏?
4. The following recursive sequence was generated starting with an initial value of 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 , and the recurrence relation
𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝟑𝟑𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊 + 𝟏𝟏, for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟎𝟎. Fill in the blanks of the sequence
5. For the recursive sequence generated by initial value, 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 , and recurrence relation, 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊 + 𝟐𝟐, for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟎𝟎, find a
formula for 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 , 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐, 𝒂𝒂𝟑𝟑, 𝒂𝒂𝟒𝟒 in terms of 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 . Describe in words what this sequence is generating.
6. For the recursive sequence generated by initial value, 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 , and recurrence relation, 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝒊𝒊 + 𝟏𝟏, for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟎𝟎, find a
formula for 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 , 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐, 𝒂𝒂𝟑𝟑, 𝒂𝒂𝟒𝟒 in terms of 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 .
Student Outcomes
Students learn the meaning and notation of recursive sequences in a modeling setting.
Students use recursive sequences to model and answer problems.
Students create equations and inequalities to solve a modeling problem.
Students represent constraints by equations and inequalities and interpret solutions as viable or non-viable
options in a modeling context.
Lesson Notes
The double and add 5 game is loosely related to the Collatz conjecture—an unsolved conjecture in mathematics named
after Lothar Collatz, who first proposed the problem in 1937. The conjecture includes a recurrence relation, triple and
add 1, as part of the problem statement. A worthwhile activity for you and your class is to read about the conjecture
online.
Students begin by playing the Double and Add 5 game in a simple situation. Given a number, double it and add 5. The
result of round two is the double of the result of round one, plus 5, and so on. The goal of the game is to find the
smallest starting whole number, 𝑎𝑎0 , that produces a number 100 or greater in three rounds or fewer (answer: 𝑎𝑎0 = 9).
Students are then exposed to the more difficult challenge of finding the smallest starting whole number that produces a
number 1,000 or greater in three rounds or fewer (answer: 𝑎𝑎0 = 121). To solve this problem, the notation of recursive
sequences and recursive relations are explained, and students formalize the problem in terms of an equation, solve,
interpret their answer, and validate.
Classwork
This challenging two-day modeling lesson (see page 61 of CCLS) about recursive sequences runs through the problem,
formulate, compute, interpret, validate, report modeling cycle. This modeling activity involves playing a game and
describing the mathematical process in the game using a recurrence relation in order to solve a more difficult version of
the game. This part two lesson picks up where the last lesson left off—in this lesson students formulate, compute,
interpret, validate, and report on their answers to the Double and Add 5 game problem stated in the previous lesson.
Recall the statement of the problem from the last lesson for your students:
Given a starting number, double it and add 5 to get the result of round one. Double the result of round one
and add 5, and so on. The goal of the game is to find the smallest starting whole number that produces a
result of 1,000 or greater in three rounds or fewer.
Example 1
Review Exercise 3 from the previous lesson: Using a generic initial value, 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 , and the recurrence relation, 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝟐𝟐𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊 + 𝟓𝟓,
for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟎𝟎, find a formula for 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 , 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 , 𝒂𝒂𝟑𝟑, 𝒂𝒂𝟒𝟒 in terms of 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 .
MP.2 Exercise 1
&
MP.4 Using one of the four formulas from Example 1, write an inequality that, if solved for 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 , will lead to finding the smallest
starting whole number for the double and add 𝟓𝟓 game that produces a result of 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 or greater in 𝟑𝟑 rounds or fewer.
This exercise is loaded with phrases that students will need to interpret correctly in order to formulate an equation (do
not expect this to be easy for them). Start with simple questions and build up:
What does 𝑎𝑎2 mean in terms of rounds?
The result of round two
Write what the statement, “produce a result of 1,000 or greater in two rounds,” means using a term of the
sequence.
The result of round two, 𝑎𝑎2 , must be greater than or equal to 1,000. Ask students to write the
equation, 𝑎𝑎2 ≥ 1000, for that statement.
After replacing 𝑎𝑎2 in the inequality, 𝑎𝑎2 ≥ 1000, with the expression in terms of 𝑎𝑎0 , what do the numbers 𝑎𝑎0
that satisfy the inequality, 4𝑎𝑎0 + 15 ≥ 1000, mean?
The numbers 𝑎𝑎0 that satisfy the inequality are the starting numbers for the Double and Add 5 game
that produce a result of 1,000 or greater in two rounds or fewer. The “or fewer” in the previous
sentence is important and can be understood by thinking about the question, “Do we need two rounds
to reach 1,000, starting with number 999? 800? 500?”
Let students solve for 𝑎𝑎0 in 4𝑎𝑎0 + 15 ≥ 1000, and let them find the smallest whole number 𝑎𝑎0 for exactly two rounds
(Answer: 247). Then continue with your questioning:
What inequality in terms of 𝑎𝑎0 would you write down to find the smallest starting number for the Double and
Add 5 game that produces a result of 1,000 or greater in three rounds or fewer?
8𝑎𝑎0 + 35 ≥ 1000
Exercise 2
MP.2 Solve the inequality derived in Exercise 1. Interpret your answer, and validate that it is the solution to the problem. That
& is, show that the whole number you found results in 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 or greater in three rounds, but the previous whole number
MP.3 takes four rounds to reach 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎.
Exercise 3 (5 minutes)
(This exercise cycles through the modeling cycle again.) Ask students:
Exercise 3
Find the smallest starting whole number for the Double and Add 𝟓𝟓 game that produces a result of 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 or greater
in four rounds or fewer.
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 ∙ 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 + 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 ≥ 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 + 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 − 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕 ≥ 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟕𝟕𝟕𝟕
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 ≥ 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗, 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗
𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏
(𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 ) ≥ (𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗, 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗)
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗, 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗
𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 ≥
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗,𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗
Students should write or say something similar to the following response: I interpreted 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 ≥ or 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 ≥
𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒. 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 as the set of all starting numbers that reach 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 or greater in four rounds or fewer. Therefore, the
smallest starting whole number is 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒. To validate, I checked that starting with 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 results in 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 after
four rounds, whereas 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 results in 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗, 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 after four rounds.
Lesson Summary
The formula, 𝒂𝒂𝒏𝒏 = 𝟐𝟐𝒏𝒏 (𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 + 𝟓𝟓) − 𝟓𝟓, describes the 𝒏𝒏th term of the double and add 5 game in terms of the starting
number 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 and 𝒏𝒏. Use this formula to find the smallest starting whole number for the double and add 5 game that
produces a result of 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 or greater in 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 rounds or fewer.
Exit Ticket
Write a brief report about the answers you found to the Double and Add 5 game problems. Include justifications for why
your starting numbers are correct.
Write a brief report about the answers you found to the Double and Add 5 game problems. Include justifications for why
your starting numbers are correct.
Results for finding the smallest starting number in the Double and Add 5 game:
1. Reaching 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 in three rounds or fewer: The starting number 𝟗𝟗 results in 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 in round three. The starting number
𝟖𝟖 results in 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 in round three, requiring another round to reach 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏. Numbers 𝟏𝟏–𝟖𝟖 take more than three rounds to
reach 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
MP.3
2. Reaching 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 in three rounds or fewer: The starting number 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 results in 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 in round three. The starting
number 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 results in 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 in round three, requiring another round to reach 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎. All other whole numbers less
than 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 take more than three rounds to reach 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎.
3. Reaching 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 in four rounds or fewer: The starting number 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 results in 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 in round four.
The starting number 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 results in 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗, 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗 in round four, requiring another round to reach 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎. All
other whole numbers less than 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔, 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒 take more than four rounds to reach 𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎.
1. Your older sibling came home from college for the weekend and showed you the following sequences (from her
homework) that she claimed were generated from initial values and recurrence relations. For each sequence, find
an initial value and recurrence relation that describes the sequence. (Your sister showed you an answer to the first
problem.)
a. (𝟎𝟎, 𝟐𝟐, 𝟒𝟒, 𝟔𝟔, 𝟖𝟖, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, … )
𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 = 𝟎𝟎 and 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊 + 𝟐𝟐 for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟏𝟏
2. Answer the following questions about the recursive sequence generated by initial value, 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 = 𝟒𝟒, and recurrence
relation, 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝒊𝒊 for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟏𝟏.
a. Find a formula for 𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 , 𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 , 𝒂𝒂𝟑𝟑 , 𝒂𝒂𝟒𝟒, 𝒂𝒂𝟓𝟓 in terms of powers of 𝟒𝟒.
𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏 = 𝟒𝟒𝟏𝟏
𝒂𝒂𝟐𝟐 = 𝟒𝟒𝟐𝟐
𝒂𝒂𝟑𝟑 = 𝟒𝟒𝟑𝟑
𝒂𝒂𝟒𝟒 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
𝒂𝒂𝟓𝟓 = 𝟒𝟒𝟓𝟓
b. Your friend, Carl, says that he can describe the 𝒏𝒏th term of the sequence using the formula, 𝒂𝒂𝒏𝒏 = 𝟒𝟒𝒏𝒏 . Is Carl
correct? Write one or two sentences using the recurrence relation to explain why or why not.
Yes. The recurrence relation, 𝒂𝒂𝒊𝒊+𝟏𝟏 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒𝒊𝒊 for 𝒊𝒊 ≥ 𝟎𝟎, means that the next term in the sequence is always 𝟒𝟒
times larger than the current term, i.e., one more power of 𝟒𝟒. Therefore, the 𝒏𝒏th term will be 𝒏𝒏 powers of 𝟒𝟒,
or 𝟒𝟒𝒏𝒏 .
3. The expression, 𝟐𝟐𝒏𝒏 (𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 + 𝟓𝟓) − 𝟓𝟓, describes the 𝒏𝒏th term of the double and add 5 game in terms of the starting
number 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 and 𝒏𝒏. Verify that it does describe the 𝒏𝒏th term by filling out the tables below for parts (b) through (e).
(The first table is done for you.)
a. Table for 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 = 𝟏𝟏
𝒏𝒏 𝟐𝟐𝒏𝒏 (𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 + 𝟓𝟓) − 𝟓𝟓
𝟏𝟏 𝟐𝟐𝟏𝟏 ∙ 𝟔𝟔 − 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟕𝟕
𝟐𝟐 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 ∙ 𝟔𝟔 − 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏
𝟑𝟑 𝟐𝟐𝟑𝟑 ∙ 𝟔𝟔 − 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒
𝟒𝟒 𝟐𝟐𝟒𝟒 ∙ 𝟔𝟔 − 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗
4. Bilbo Baggins stated to Samwise Gamgee, “Today, Sam, I will give you $𝟏𝟏. Every day thereafter for the next 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 days,
I will take the previous day’s amount, double it and add $𝟓𝟓, and give that new amount to you for that day.”
a. How much did Bilbo give Sam on day 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏? (Hint: You don’t have to compute each term.)
𝒂𝒂𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 = 𝟐𝟐𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 (𝟏𝟏 + 𝟓𝟓) − 𝟓𝟓 = 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔. Bilbo gave Sam $𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔𝟔 on day 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏.
Yes. He gave $𝟗𝟗𝟗𝟗, 𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐 on day 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, $𝟒𝟒𝟒𝟒, 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, on day 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, $𝟐𝟐𝟐𝟐, 𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓𝟓 on day 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, and so on.
5. The formula, 𝒂𝒂𝒏𝒏 = 𝟐𝟐𝒏𝒏−𝟏𝟏 (𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 + 𝟓𝟓) − 𝟓𝟓, describes the 𝒏𝒏th term of the Double and Add 5 game in terms of the starting
number 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 and 𝒏𝒏. Use this formula to find the smallest starting whole number for the Double and Add 5 game that
produces a result of 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 or greater in 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 rounds or fewer.
Solving 𝟐𝟐𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 (𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 + 𝟓𝟓) − 𝟓𝟓 ≥ 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 for 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 results in 𝒂𝒂𝟎𝟎 ≥ 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑. 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 ….
Hence, 𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑𝟑 is the smallest starting whole number that will reach 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎𝟎 in 𝟏𝟏𝟏𝟏 rounds or fewer.
Student Outcomes
Students create equations and inequalities in one variable and use them to solve problems.
Students create equations in two or more variables to represent relationships between quantities and graph
equations on coordinate axes with labels and scales.
Students represent constraints by inequalities and interpret solutions as viable or non-viable options in a
modeling context.
Lesson Notes
This real-life descriptive modeling lesson (see page 61 of the CCLS or page 71 of the CCSS) is about using inequalities and
graphs to understand the progressive federal tax system. Like the last lesson, this lesson again runs through the
problem, formulate, compute, interpret, validate, report modeling cycle, but unlike the difficult modeling lesson on the
Double and Add 5 game, more autonomy can be given to students in this lesson. You might want to include more
discussion of the words and process used in the modeling cycle:
Materials
Please ensure that each student has a copy of the tax tables (on the next page) in their student materials or as a
handout. Students will need a calculator and (your call) a spreadsheet program.
Classwork
Mathematical Modeling Exercise
Formulating the Problem (15 minutes)
Tell students: The federal income tax is not calculated by summing up all that an individual earns and then taking a fixed
percentage of that income. Instead, the federal tax system is progressive. That means the more an individual makes,
the greater the percentage of it is taxed. In this lesson, we will analyze our tax system, graph the federal income tax
versus income, and use the graph to compute effective tax rates for families with different incomes.
Exemption
Exemption Class
Deduction
Single $𝟑, 𝟗𝟎𝟎
Married $𝟕, 𝟖𝟎𝟎
Married with 1 child $𝟏𝟏, 𝟕𝟎𝟎
Married with 2 children $𝟏𝟓, 𝟔𝟎𝟎
Married with 3 children $𝟏𝟗, 𝟓𝟎𝟎
Standard Deductions Based Upon Filing Status for Tax Year 2013
Federal Income Tax for Married Filing Jointly for Tax Year 2013
Plus the
If taxable income is
But not over-- The tax is: Marginal Of the amount over--
over--
Rate
$𝟎 $𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎 𝟏𝟎% $𝟎
$𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎 $𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎 $𝟏, 𝟕𝟖𝟓. 𝟎𝟎 𝟏𝟓% $𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎
$𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎 $𝟏𝟒𝟔, 𝟒𝟎𝟎 $𝟗, 𝟗𝟖𝟐. 𝟓𝟎 𝟐𝟓% $𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎
$𝟏𝟒𝟔, 𝟒𝟎𝟎 $𝟐𝟐𝟑, 𝟎𝟓𝟎 $𝟐𝟖, 𝟒𝟓𝟕. 𝟓𝟎 𝟐𝟖% $𝟏𝟒𝟔, 𝟒𝟎𝟎
$𝟐𝟐𝟑, 𝟎𝟓𝟎 $𝟑𝟗𝟖, 𝟑𝟓𝟎 $𝟒𝟗, 𝟗𝟏𝟗. 𝟓𝟎 𝟑𝟑% $𝟐𝟐𝟑, 𝟎𝟓𝟎
$𝟑𝟗𝟖, 𝟑𝟓𝟎 $𝟒𝟓𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 $𝟏𝟎𝟕, 𝟕𝟔𝟖. 𝟓𝟎 𝟑𝟓% $𝟑𝟗𝟖, 𝟑𝟓𝟎
$𝟒𝟓𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 + $𝟏𝟐𝟓, 𝟖𝟒𝟔. 𝟎𝟎 𝟑𝟗. 𝟔% $𝟒𝟓𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎
Taxable Income: The U.S. government considers the income of a family (or individual) to include the sum of any money
earned from a husband’s or wife’s jobs, and money made from their personal businesses or investments. The taxes for a
household (i.e., an individual or family) are not computed from the income; rather, they are computed from the
household’s taxable income. For many families, the household’s taxable income is simply the household’s income minus
exemption deductions and minus standard deductions:
All of the problems we will model in this lesson will use this equation to find a family’s taxable income. The only
exception is if the family’s taxable income is less than zero, in which case we will say that the family’s taxable income is
just $𝟎.
Use this formula and the tables above to answer the following questions about taxable income:
Exercise 1
Find the taxable income of a single person with no kids, who has an income of $𝟓𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
𝟓𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟑, 𝟗𝟎𝟎 − 𝟔, 𝟏𝟎𝟎 = 𝟒𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎. The family’s taxable income is $𝟒𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
Exercise 2
MP.2
Find the taxable income of a married couple with two children, who have a combined income of $𝟓𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
𝟓𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟏𝟓, 𝟔𝟎𝟎 − 𝟏𝟐, 𝟐𝟎𝟎 = 𝟐𝟕, 𝟐𝟎𝟎. The family’s taxable income is $𝟐𝟕, 𝟐𝟎𝟎.
Exercise 3
Find the taxable income of a married couple with one child, who have a combined income of $𝟐𝟑, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
𝟐𝟑, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟏𝟏, 𝟕𝟎𝟎 − 𝟏𝟐, 𝟐𝟎𝟎 = −𝟗𝟎𝟎. The family’s taxable income is $𝟎.
Federal Income Tax and the Marginal Tax Rate: Below is an example of how to compute the federal income tax of a
household using the Federal Income Tax table above.
Example 1
Compute the Federal Income Tax for the situation described in Exercise 1 (a single person with no kids making $𝟓𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎).
From the answer in Exercise 1, the taxable income is $𝟒𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎. Looking up $𝟒𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 in the tax table above, we see that
$𝟒𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 corresponds to the second row because it is between $𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎 and $𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎:
Plus the
If taxable income is
But not over-- The tax is: Marginal Of the amount over--
over--
Rate
$𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎 $𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎 $𝟏, 𝟕𝟖𝟓. 𝟎𝟎 𝟏𝟓% $𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎
To calculate the tax, add $𝟏, 𝟕𝟖𝟓 plus 𝟏𝟓% of the amount of $𝟒𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 that is over $𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎. Since 𝟒𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎 =
𝟐𝟕, 𝟏𝟓𝟎, and 𝟏𝟓% of 𝟐𝟕, 𝟏𝟓𝟎 is $𝟒, 𝟎𝟕𝟐. 𝟓𝟎, the total federal income tax on $𝟒𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 of taxable income is $𝟓, 𝟖𝟓𝟕. 𝟓𝟎.
Exercise 4
Compute the Federal Income Tax for a married couple with two children making $𝟏𝟐𝟕, 𝟖𝟎𝟎.
The taxable income is $𝟏𝟐𝟕, 𝟖𝟎𝟎 − $𝟏𝟓, 𝟔𝟎𝟎 − $𝟏𝟐, 𝟐𝟎𝟎 = $𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
Looking up $𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 in the tax table, we see that $𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 corresponds to the third row because it is between
$𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎 and $𝟏𝟒𝟔, 𝟎𝟎𝟎:
To calculate the tax, add $𝟗𝟗𝟖𝟐. 𝟓𝟎 plus 𝟐𝟓% of the amount over $𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎. Since 𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎 = 𝟐𝟕, 𝟓𝟎𝟎, we
take 𝟐𝟓% of 𝟐𝟕, 𝟓𝟎𝟎 to get $𝟔𝟖𝟕𝟓. Thus, the total federal income tax on $𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 of taxable income is $𝟏𝟔, 𝟖𝟓𝟕. 𝟓𝟎.
Taxpayers sometimes misunderstand marginal tax to mean: “If my taxable income is $𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎, and my marginal tax
rate is 𝟐𝟓%, my federal income taxes are $𝟐𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.” This statement is not true—they would not owe $𝟐𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 to the
federal government. Instead, a marginal income tax charges a progressively higher tax rate for successively greater levels
of income. Therefore, they would really owe:
𝟏𝟎% on the first $𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎, or $𝟏, 𝟕𝟖𝟓 in taxes for the interval from $𝟎 to $𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎;
𝟏𝟓% on the next $𝟓𝟒, 𝟔𝟓𝟎, or $𝟖, 𝟏𝟗𝟕. 𝟓𝟎 in taxes for the interval from $𝟏𝟕, 𝟖𝟓𝟎 to $𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎;
𝟐𝟓% on the last $𝟐𝟕, 𝟓𝟎𝟎, or $𝟔, 𝟖𝟕𝟓. 𝟎𝟎 in taxes for the interval from $𝟕𝟐, 𝟓𝟎𝟎 to $𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎;
for a total of $𝟏𝟔, 𝟖𝟓𝟕. 𝟓𝟎 of the $𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 of taxable income. Thus, their effective federal income tax rate is
𝟏𝟔. 𝟖𝟓𝟕𝟓%, not 𝟐𝟓% as they claimed. Note that the tax table above incorporates the different intervals so that only one
calculation needs to be made (the answer to this problem is the same as the answer in Exercise 5).
Exercise 5
The creation of the table and the graph involves many of the ideas that students have been learning throughout this
module. The hope here is that they can work through this problem on their own (or in groups of two) with minimum
help from you. However, since these tax terms are new, you may need to walk around the room and help explain words
like income, taxable income, exemption, standard deduction, and federal income tax (as well as marginal tax rate, filing
status, and deduction).
Exercise 5
MP.1
& Create a table and a graph of federal income tax versus income for a married couple with two children between $𝟎 of
MP.4 income and $𝟓𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 of income.
The first step in creating the graph is to determine the equation for taxable income. A married couple with two children
has a standard deduction of $𝟏𝟐, 𝟐𝟎𝟎 and an exemption deduction of $𝟏𝟓, 𝟔𝟎𝟎, for a total deduction of $𝟐𝟕, 𝟖𝟎𝟎. If we
let the real number, 𝑻𝑰, stand for the family’s taxable income, and the real number, 𝑰, stand for the family’s income, we
get the following equation for taxable income:
𝑰 − 𝟐𝟕𝟖𝟎𝟎 𝑰 ≥ 𝟐𝟕𝟖𝟎𝟎
𝑻𝑰 = {
𝟎 𝟎 ≤ 𝑰 < 𝟐𝟕𝟖𝟎𝟎
Help students to create the following table using the intervals in the
160
federal income tax table:
Thousands
Federal Income Tax (dollars)
140
Income ($) Taxable Income ($) Federal Income Tax ($) 120
0 0 0 100
27,800 0 0
80
45,650 17,850 1785.00
60
100,300 72,500 9,982.50
174,200 146,400 28,457.50 40
250,850 223,050 49,919.50 20
426,150 398,350 107,768.50 0
477,800 450,000 125,846.00 0 200 400
Thousands
500,000 472,200 134,637.20
Income (dollars)
Use column 1 and column 3 in this table to create the graph on the right.
Exercise 6
Interpret and validate the graph you created in Exercise 5. Does your graph provide an approximate value for the federal
income tax you calculated in Exercise 4?
Yes. The graph suggests that the federal income tax for a married couple with two children with an income
of $𝟏𝟐𝟕, 𝟖𝟎𝟎 should be between $𝟏𝟓, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 and $𝟐𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎, which is close to the actual amount of $𝟏𝟔, 𝟖𝟓𝟕. 𝟓𝟎.
Exercise 7
Use the table you created in Exercise 5 to report on the effective federal income tax rate for a married couple with two
children, who makes:
a. $𝟐𝟕, 𝟖𝟎𝟎
b. $𝟒𝟓, 𝟔𝟓𝟎
c. $𝟓𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎
Note to teacher: Answer the first two incomes with your class, using them as examples to explain the meaning of
effective federal income tax rate. Let them find the effective federal income tax rate for $500,000 as an exercise.
The effective federal income tax rate is found by writing the number (federal income tax)/(income) as a percentage. The
effective federal income tax rate for a married couple with two children making:
Exit Ticket
A famous movie actress made $10 million last year. She is married and has no children, and her husband does not earn
any income. Assume that she computes her taxable income using the following formula:
Find her taxable income, her federal income tax, and her effective federal income tax rate.
A famous movie actress made $𝟏𝟎 million last year. She is married and has no children, and her husband does not earn
any income. Assume that she computes her taxable income using the following formula:
Find her taxable income, her federal income tax, and her effective federal income tax rate.
Taxable Income: $𝟏𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 − $𝟕, 𝟖𝟎𝟎 − $𝟏𝟐, 𝟐𝟎𝟎 = $𝟗, 𝟗𝟖𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎
𝟑𝟗. 𝟔% of 𝟗, 𝟗𝟖𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 − 𝟒𝟓𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎, or 𝟑𝟗. 𝟔% of 𝟗, 𝟓𝟑𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎, is $𝟑, 𝟕𝟕𝟑, 𝟖𝟖𝟎 in tax over the first $𝟒𝟓𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎. Add the tax
of $𝟏𝟐𝟓, 𝟖𝟒𝟔 on the first $𝟒𝟓𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎 of taxable income, to get a total federal income tax of $𝟑, 𝟖𝟗𝟗, 𝟕𝟐𝟔.
𝟑,𝟖𝟗𝟗,𝟕𝟐𝟔
Effective Federal Income Tax Rate: ⋅ 𝟏𝟎𝟎 ≈ 𝟑𝟗%
𝟏𝟎,𝟎𝟎𝟎,𝟎𝟎𝟎
Use the formula and tax tables given in the lesson to perform all computations.
1. Find the taxable income of a married couple with two children, who have a combined income of $𝟕𝟓, 𝟎𝟎0.
$𝟒𝟕, 𝟐𝟎𝟎
2. Find the taxable income of a single person with no children, who has an income of $𝟑𝟕, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
$𝟐𝟕, 𝟎𝟎𝟎
3. Find the taxable income of a married couple with three children, who have a combined income of $𝟔𝟐, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
$𝟑𝟎, 𝟑𝟎𝟎
4. Find the federal income tax of a married couple with two children, who have a combined income of $𝟏𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
$𝟗, 𝟗𝟑𝟕. 𝟓𝟎
5. Find the federal income tax of a married couple with three children, who have a combined income of $𝟑𝟎𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
$𝟔𝟒, 𝟖𝟓𝟐
6. Find the effective federal income tax rate of a married couple with no children, who have a combined income of
$𝟑𝟒, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
𝟒. 𝟏%
7. Find the effective federal income tax rate of a married couple with one child who have a combined income of
$𝟐𝟓𝟎, 𝟎𝟎𝟎.
~𝟐𝟎. 𝟒%
8. The latest report on median household (family) income in the United States is $𝟓𝟎, 𝟓𝟎𝟐 per year. Compute the
federal income tax and effective federal income tax rate for a married couple with three children, who have a
combined income of $𝟓𝟎, 𝟓𝟎𝟐.
9. Extend the table you created in Exercise 6 by adding a column called, “Effective federal income tax rate.” Compute
the effective federal income tax rate to the nearest tenth for each row of the table, and create a graph that shows
effective federal income tax rate versus income using the table.
30%
25%
20%
15%
10%
5%
0%
0 200 400 600
Thousands
Income (dollars)
Name Date
1. Solve the following equations for 𝑥𝑥. Write your answer in set notation.
a. 3𝑥𝑥 − 5 = 16
b. 3(𝑥𝑥 + 3) − 5 = 16
c. 3(2𝑥𝑥 − 3) − 5 = 16
d. 6(𝑥𝑥 + 3) − 10 = 32
e. Which two equations above have the same solution set? Write a sentence explaining how the
properties of equality can be used to determine the pair without having to find the solution set for
each.
a. If 𝑐𝑐 = 42 + 𝑑𝑑 is true, then which is greater: 𝑐𝑐 or 𝑑𝑑, or are you not able to tell? Explain how you
know your choice is correct.
b. If 𝑐𝑐 = 42 − 𝑑𝑑 is true, then which is greater: 𝑐𝑐 or 𝑑𝑑, or are you not able to tell? Explain how you
know your choice is correct.
4. Solve for x in each of the equations or inequalities below, and name the property and/or properties used:
3
a. 𝑥𝑥 =9
4
b. 10 + 3𝑥𝑥 = 5𝑥𝑥
c. 𝑎𝑎 + 𝑥𝑥 = 𝑏𝑏
d. 𝑐𝑐𝑐𝑐 = 𝑑𝑑
1
e. 𝑥𝑥 − 𝑔𝑔 < 𝑚𝑚
2
f. 𝑞𝑞 + 5𝑥𝑥 = 7𝑥𝑥 − 𝑟𝑟
3
g. (𝑥𝑥 + 2) = 6(𝑥𝑥 + 12)
4
a. Explain why the equation (3𝑥𝑥 + 4) + 4 = (5𝑥𝑥 − 4) + 4 also has the solution set {4}.
b. In part (a), the expression (3𝑥𝑥 + 4) + 4 is equivalent to the expression 3𝑥𝑥 + 8. What is the
definition of equivalent expressions? Why does changing an expression on one side of an equation
to an equivalent expression leave the solution set unchanged?
c. When we square both sides of the original equation, we get the following new equation:
Show that 4 is still a solution to the new equation. Show that 0 is also a solution to the new
equation but is not a solution to the original equation. Write a sentence that describes how the
solution set to an equation may change when both sides of the equation are squared.
d. When we replace 𝑥𝑥 by 𝑥𝑥 2 in the original equation, we get the following new equation:
3𝑥𝑥 2 + 4 = 5𝑥𝑥 2 − 4.
Use the fact that the solution set to the original equation is {4} to find the solution set to this new
equation.
6. The Zonda Information and Telephone Company (ZI&T) calculates a customer’s total monthly cell phone
charge using the formula,
where 𝐶𝐶 is the total cell phone charge, 𝑏𝑏 is a basic monthly fee, 𝑟𝑟 is the rate per minute, 𝑚𝑚 is the number
of minutes used that month, and 𝑡𝑡 is the tax rate.
Solve for 𝑚𝑚, the number of minutes the customer used that month.
7. Students and adults purchased tickets for a recent basketball playoff game. All tickets were sold at the
ticket booth—season passes, discounts, etc. were not allowed.
Student tickets cost $5 each, and adult tickets cost $10 each. A total of $4,500 was collected. 700
tickets were sold.
a. Write a system of equations that can be used to find the number of student tickets, 𝑠𝑠, and the
number of adult tickets, 𝑎𝑎, that were sold at the playoff game.
b. Assuming that the number of students and adults attending would not change, how much more
money could have been collected at the playoff game if the ticket booth charged students and adults
the same price of $10 per ticket?
c. Assuming that the number of students and adults attending would not change, how much more
money could have been collected at the playoff game if the student price was kept at $5 per ticket
and adults were charged $15 per ticket instead of $10?
8. Alexus is modeling the growth of bacteria for an experiment in science. She assumes that there are 𝐵𝐵
bacteria in a Petri dish at 12:00 noon. In reality, each bacterium in the Petri dish subdivides into two new
bacteria approximately every 20 minutes. However, for the purposes of the model, Alexus assumes that
each bacterium subdivides into two new bacteria exactly every 20 minutes.
1
a. Create a table that shows the total number of bacteria in the Petri dish at hour intervals for 2 hours
3
starting with time 0 to represent 12:00 noon.
b. Write an equation that describes the relationship between total number of bacteria 𝑇𝑇 and time ℎ in
hours, assuming there are 𝐵𝐵 bacteria in the Petri dish at ℎ = 0.
c. If Alexus starts with 100 bacteria in the Petri dish, draw a graph that displays the total number of
bacteria with respect to time from 12:00 noon (ℎ = 0) to 4:00 p.m. (ℎ = 4). Label points on your
graph at time ℎ = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4.
d. For her experiment, Alexus plans to add an anti-bacterial chemical to the Petri dish at 4:00 p.m. that
is supposed to kill 99.9% of the bacteria instantaneously. If she started with 100 bacteria at 12:00
noon, how many live bacteria might Alexus expect to find in the Petri dish right after she adds the
anti-bacterial chemical?
9. Jack is 27 years older than Susan. In 5 years, he will be 4 times as old as she is.
10.
a. Find the product: (𝑥𝑥 2 − 𝑥𝑥 + 1)(2𝑥𝑥 2 + 3𝑥𝑥 + 2).
b. Use the results of part (a) to factor 21,112 as a product of a two-digit number and a three-digit
number.
Equation A1: 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑥𝑥 + 1
a. Write a unique system of two linear equations with the same solution set. This time make both
linear equations have positive slope.
b. The following system of equations was obtained from the original system by adding a multiple of
equation A2 to equation A1.
Equation C1: 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑥𝑥 + 1
d. For any real number 𝑚𝑚, the line 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑚𝑚(𝑥𝑥 − 3) + 4 passes through the point (3,4).
Equation D1: 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑥𝑥 + 1
12. The local theater in Jamie’s home town has a maximum capacity of 160 people. Jamie shared with Venus
the following graph and said that the shaded region represented all the possible combinations of adult
and child tickets that could be sold for one show.
a. Venus objected and said there was more than one reason that Jamie’s thinking was flawed. What
reasons could Venus be thinking of?
b. Use equations, inequalities, graphs, and/or words to describe for Jamie the set of all possible
combinations of adult and child tickets that could be sold for one show.
c. The theater charges $9 for each adult ticket and $6 for each child ticket. The theater sold 144
tickets for the first showing of the new release. The total money collected from ticket sales for that
show was $1,164. Write a system of equations that could be used to find the number of child
tickets and the number of adult tickets sold, and solve the system algebraically. Summarize your
findings using the context of the problem.
e Student did not Student answered (b) Student answered (b) Student answered (b)
answer or answered and (d) but did not and (d) but made and (d) and articulated
A-SSE.A.1b incorrectly with demonstrate solid minor misstatements solid reasoning in the
A-REI.B.3 something other reasoning in the in the explanation. explanation.
than (b) and (d). explanation.
5 a Student did not Student demonstrated Student demonstrated Student answer was
answer or only limited solid reasoning but fell complete and
A-REI.A.1 demonstrated reasoning. short of a complete demonstrated solid
incorrect reasoning answer or made a reasoning throughout.
throughout. minor misstatement in
the answer.
b Student did not Student made more Student provided a Student answered
answer or did not than one mostly correct completely and used a
A-REI.A.1 demonstrate misstatement in the definition with a correct definition
understanding of definition. minor misstatement. without error or mis-
what the question statement.
was asking.
d Student answered Student identified one Student identified Student identified both
incorrectly or did or both solutions but only one solution solutions correctly and
A-REI.A.1 not answer. was unable to convey correctly but articulated the
how the solutions articulated the reasoning of using the
could be found using reasoning of using the solution to the original
the fact that 4 is a solution to the original equation to find the
solution to the original equation to find the solution to the new
equation. solution to the new equation.
equation.
6 A-CED.A.4 Student did not Student made more Student answer Student answered
answer or showed than one error in the showed valid steps correctly.
no evidence of solution process but but with one minor
reasoning. showed some error.
evidence of reasoning.
7 a–c Student was unable Student answered one Student showed solid Student answered
to answer any part correctly or evidence of reasoning every part correctly
A-CED.A.3 portion correctly. showed some in every part but may and demonstrated and
evidence of reasoning have made minor expressed valid
in more than one part. errors. reasoning throughout.
9 a Student wrote Student answers were Both equations were Both equations were
incorrect equations incorrect, but at least correct, but student correct and student
A-CED.A.1 or did not provide one of the equations made a minor mistake solved them correctly
equations. was correct. Student in finding the solution. to arrive at the answer
may have made a that Jack is 31 and
gross error in the Susan is 4.
solution, made more
10 a–b Student work was Student made more Student demonstrated Student demonstrated
blank or than one error in the the ability to multiply the ability to multiply
A-APR.A.1 demonstrated no multiplication but the polynomials the polynomials
understanding of demonstrated some (expressing the (expressing the product
multiplication of understanding of product as a sum of as a sum of monomials
polynomials, nor multiplication of monomials with like with like terms
how to apply part polynomials. Student terms combined) and combined) and to apply
(a) to arrive at an may not have been to apply the structure the structure from part
answer for part (b). able to garner or apply from part (a) to solve (a) to solve part (b) as
information from part part (b). There may 91(232).
(a) to use in answering have been minor
part (b) correctly. errors.
11 a Student was unable Student provided two Student showed one Student provided two
to demonstrate the equations that have minor error in the equations both
A-REI.C.6 understanding that (3, 4) as a solution (or answer but attempted containing (3, 4) as a
two equations with attempted to provide to provide two solution and both with
(3, 4) as a solution such equations) but equations both positive slope.
are needed. made one or more containing (3, 4) as a
errors. Student may solution and both with
have provided an positive slope.
equation with a
negative slope.
c Student was unable Student showed some Student made a minor Student successfully
to demonstrate reasoning required to error in finding the identified the solution
A-REI.C.6 even a partial find the solution but solution point. point as (3, 4).
understanding of made multiple errors.
how to find the
solution to the
system.
d Student was unable Student concluded yes Student correctly Student correctly
to answer or to or no but was only explained that all the explained that while in
A-REI.C.5 support the answer able to express limited systems would have most cases this is true,
A-REI.C.6 with any solid reasoning in support the solution point if 𝑚𝑚 = 1, the two lines
reasoning. of the answer. (3, 4) but incorrectly are coinciding lines,
A-REI.D.10
assumed this is true resulting in a solution
for all cases of 𝑚𝑚. set consisting of all the
points on the line.
12 a Student was unable Student was only able Student provided two Student was able to
to articulate any to articulate one sound reasons but articulate at least two
MP.2 sound reasons. sound reason. made minor errors in valid reasons. Valid
A-REI.D.12 the expression of reasons include the
reasoning. following: the graph
assumes 𝑥𝑥 could be less
than zero, the graph
assumes 𝑦𝑦 could be less
than zero, the graph
assumes 𝑎𝑎 and 𝑏𝑏 could
be non-whole numbers,
the graph assumes 160
children could attend
with no adults.
b Student was unable Student provided a Student made minor Student communicated
to communicate a verbal description that errors in effectively that both (a)
A-CED.A.2 relevant lacked precision and communicating the and (b) must be whole
A-REI.D.10 requirement of the accuracy but idea that both (a) and numbers whose sum is
solution set. demonstrated some (b) must be whole less than or equal to
A-REI.D.12
reasoning about the numbers whose sum 160.
solution within the is less than or equal to
context of the 160.
problem.
c Student was unable Student made Student made minor Student correctly wrote
to demonstrate any multiple errors in the errors in the the equations to
A-CED.A.2 substantive equations and/or equations but solved represent the system.
A-REI.C.6 understanding in solving process but the system accurately, Student solved the
how to create the demonstrated some or the student created system accurately and
equations and solve understanding of how the correct equations summarized by
the system of to create equations to but made a minor defining or describing
equations. represent a context error in solving the the values of the
and/or solve the system of equations. variable in the context
system of equations. of the problem (i.e.,
that there were 100
adult tickets and 44
child tickets sold.
Name Date
1. Solve the following equations for 𝑥𝑥. Write your answer in set notation.
a. 3𝑥𝑥 − 5 = 16
b. 3(𝑥𝑥 + 3) − 5 = 16
c. 3(2𝑥𝑥 − 3) − 5 = 16
d. 6(𝑥𝑥 + 3) − 10 = 32
2. Which two equations above have the same solution set? Write a sentence explaining how the properties
of equality can be used to determine the pair without having to find the solution set for each.
Problems (b) and (d) have the same solution set. The expressions on each side of the equal
sign for (d) are twice those for (b). So, if (left side) = (right side) is true for only some x-
values, then 2(left side) = 2(right side) will be true for exactly the same x-values. Or
simply, applying the multiplicative property of equality does not change the solution set.
a. If 𝑐𝑐 = 42 + 𝑑𝑑 is true, then which is greater: 𝑐𝑐 or 𝑑𝑑 or are you not able to tell? Explain how you know
your choice is correct.
b. If 𝑐𝑐 = 42 − 𝑑𝑑 is true, then which is greater: 𝑐𝑐 or 𝑑𝑑 or are you not able to tell? Explain how you know
your choice is correct.
There is no way to tell. We only know that the sum of c and d is 42. If d were 10, c
would be 32 and, therefore, greater than d. But if d were 40, c would be 2 and,
therefore, less than d.
4. Solve for x in each of the equations or inequalities below and name the property and/or properties used:
3
a. 𝑥𝑥 =9
4
4
x =9 ∙ � � Multiplication Property of Equality
3
x = 12
b. 10 + 3𝑥𝑥 = 5𝑥𝑥
c. 𝑎𝑎 + 𝑥𝑥 = 𝑏𝑏
d. 𝑐𝑐𝑐𝑐 = 𝑑𝑑
d
x= , c≠0 Multiplication Property of Equality
c
1
e. 𝑥𝑥 − 𝑔𝑔 < 𝑚𝑚
2
1
x<m+g Addition Property of Equality
2
x < 2 ⋅ �m + g� Multiplication Property of Equality
f. 𝑞𝑞 + 5𝑥𝑥 = 7𝑥𝑥 − 𝑟𝑟
3
g. (𝑥𝑥 + 2) = 6(𝑥𝑥 + 12)
4
3 ∙ (x + 2) = 24 ∙ (x + 12) Multiplication Property of Equality
3x + 6 = 24x + 288 Distributive Property
282
− =x Addition Property of Equality and Multiplication
21
94
− =x Property of Equality
7
94
− =x
7
a. Explain why the equation, (3𝑥𝑥 + 4) + 4 = (5𝑥𝑥 − 4) + 4, also has the solution set {4}.
Since the new equation can be created by applying the additive property of equality,
the solution set does not change.
OR
Each side of this equation is 4 more than the sides of the original equation. Whatever
value(s) make 3x + 4 = 5x − 4 true would also make 4 more than 3x + 4 equal to 4
more than 5x − 4.
b. In part (a), the expression (3𝑥𝑥 + 4) + 4 is equivalent to the expression 3𝑥𝑥 + 8. What is the
definition of equivalent algebraic expressions? Describe why changing an expression on one side of
an equation to an equivalent expression leaves the solution set unchanged?
c. When we square both sides of the original equation, we get the following new equation:
Show that 4 is still a solution to the new equation. Show that 0 is also a solution to the new
equation but is not a solution to the original equation. Write a sentence that describes how the
solution set to an equation may change when both sides of the equation are squared.
d. When we replace 𝑥𝑥 by 𝑥𝑥 2 in the original equation, we get the following new equation:
3𝑥𝑥 2 + 4 = 5𝑥𝑥 2 − 4.
Use the fact that the solution set to the original equation is {4} to find the solution set to this new
equation.
Since the original equation 3x + 4 = 5x − 4 was true when x = 4, the new equation
3x2 + 4 = 5x2 − 4 should be true when x2 = 4. And, x2 = 4 when x = 2, so the solution set
to the new equation is {−2,2}.
6. The Zonda Information and Telephone Company (ZI&T) calculates a customer’s total monthly cell phone
charge using the formula,
where 𝐶𝐶 is the total cell phone charge, 𝑏𝑏 is a basic monthly fee, 𝑟𝑟 is the rate per minute, 𝑚𝑚 is the number
of minutes used that month, and 𝑡𝑡 is the tax rate.
Solve for 𝑚𝑚, the number of minutes the customer used that month.
C = b + bt + rm + rmt
C − b − bt = m ∙ (r + rt)
C − b − bt
=m t≠ −1
r + rt
r≠0
7. Students and adults purchased tickets for a recent basketball playoff game. All tickets were sold at the
ticket booth—season passes, discounts, etc. were not allowed.
Student tickets cost $5 each, and adult tickets cost $10 each. A total of $4,500 was collected. 700
tickets were sold.
a. Write a system of equations that can be used to find the number of student tickets, 𝑠𝑠, and the
number of adult tickets, 𝑎𝑎, that were sold at the playoff game.
5s + 10a = 4500
�
s + a = 700
b. Assuming that the number of students and adults attending would not change, how much more
money could have been collected at the playoff game if the ticket booth charged students and adults
the same price of $10 per ticket?
c. Assuming that the number of students and adults attending would not change, how much more
money could have been collected at the playoff game if the student price was kept at $5 per ticket
and adults were charged $15 per ticket instead of $10?
8. Alexus is modeling the growth of bacteria for an experiement in science. She assumes that there are 𝐵𝐵
bacteria in a Petri Dish at 12:00 noon. In reality, each bacterium in the Petri dish subdivides into two new
bacteria approximately every 20 minutes. However, for the purposes of the model, Alexus assumes that
each bacterium subdivides into two new bacteria exactly every 20 minutes.
1
a. Create a table that shows the total number of bacteria in the Petri dish at hour intervals for 2 hours
3
starting with time 0 to represent 12:00 noon.
b. Write an equation that describes the relationship between total number of bacteria T and time h in
hours, assuming there are 𝐵𝐵 bacteria in the Petri dish at h=0.
T = B ∙ (2)3h or T = B ∙ 8h
c. If Alexus starts with 100 bacteria in the Petri dish, draw a graph that displays the total number of
bacteria with respect to time from 12:00 noon (ℎ = 0) to 4:00 p.m. (ℎ = 4). Label points on your
graph at time ℎ = 0,1,2,3,4.
d. For her experiment, Alexus plans to add an anti-bacterial chemical to the Petri dish at 4:00 p.m. that
is supposed to kill 99.9% of the bacteria instantaneously. If she started with 100 bacteria at 12:00
noon, how many live bacteria might Alexus expect to find in the Petri dish right after she adds the
anti-bacterial chemical?
9. Jack is 27 years older than Susan. In 5 years time he will be 4 times as old as she is.
S + 27 + 5 = 4S + 20
S + 32 = 4S + 20
12 = 3S
S=4
J = 4 + 27
J = 31
10.
a. Find the product: �𝑥𝑥 2 – 𝑥𝑥 + 1�(2𝑥𝑥 2 + 3𝑥𝑥 + 2)
b. Use the results of part (a) to factor 21,112 as a product of a two-digit number and a three-digit
number.
(100 − 10 + 1) ∙ (200 + 30 + 2)
(91) ∙ (232)
Equation A1: 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑥𝑥 + 1
a. Write a unique system of two linear equations with the same solution set. This time make both
linear equations have positive slope.
4
Equation B1: y= x
3
b. The following system of equations was obtained from the original system by adding a multiple of
equation A2 to equation A1.
Equation C1: 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑥𝑥 + 1
(3,4)
d. For any real number 𝑚𝑚, the line 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑚𝑚(𝑥𝑥 − 3) + 4 passes through the point (3,4).
Equation D1: 𝑦𝑦 = 𝑥𝑥 + 1
No. If m = 1, then the two lines have the same slope. Since both lines pass through the
point (3,4), and the lines are parallel; therefore, they coincide. There are infinite
solutions. The solution set is all the points on the line. Any other non-zero value of m
would create a system with the only solution of (3,4).
12. The local theater in Jamie’s home town has a maximum capacity of 160 people. Jamie shared with Venus
the following graph and said that the shaded region represented all the possible combinations of adult
and child tickets that could be sold for one show.
a. Venus objected and said there was more than one reason that Jamie’s thinking was flawed. What
reasons could Venus be thinking of?
1. The graph implies that the number of tickets sold could be a fractional amount,
but really it only makes sense to sell whole number tickets. x and y must be
whole numbers.
2. The graph also shows that negative ticket amounts could be sold which does not
make sense.
b. Use equations, inequalities, graphs, and/or words to describe for Jamie the set of all possible
combinations of adult and child tickets that could be sold for one show.
a + c ≤ 160
The system would be � a ≥ 0 where a and c are whole numbers.
c≥0
c. The theater charges $9 for each adult ticket and $6 for each child ticket. The theater sold 144 tickets
for the first showing of the new release. The total money collected from ticket sales for that show
was $1,164. Write a system of equations that could be used to find the number of child tickets and
the number of adult tickets sold, and solve the system algebraically. Summarize your findings using
the context of the problem.
9a + 6c = 1164
-6a − 6c = -864
3a = 300
a = 100, c = 44